Leica Model Vehicle 1000Z01 User Manual

TPS - System 1000  
Programs  
Version 2.2  
English  
TCA 1800  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TPS - System 1000  
Programs  
Product identification  
Enter your programs' version number in your manual  
and always refer to this information when you need to  
contact your agency or authorized service workshop.  
Version number:  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Symbols used in this Manual  
The symbols used in this User's Manual have the  
following meanings:  
DANGER :  
Indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if  
not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.  
WARNING :  
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation or an  
unintended use which, if not avoided, could result in  
death or serious injury.  
CAUTION :  
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation or an  
unintended use which, if not avoided, may result in  
minor or moderate injury and / or appreciable material,  
financial and environmental damage.  
Important paragraphs which must be adhered to in  
practice as they enable the product to be used in a  
technically correct and efficient manner.  
4
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
View of chapters  
CO  
IN  
Contents  
6
11  
23  
Introduction  
General notes  
Orientation and Height Transfer  
Resection  
GN  
27 OH  
39 RE  
49 TD  
59 SO  
79 FS  
Tie Distance  
Stakeout  
Free Station  
Reference Line  
Remote Height  
Hidden Point  
Area (Computation of Area)  
Sets of Angles  
Traverse  
93 RL  
105 RH  
111  
117  
129  
147  
165  
171  
205  
249  
303  
333  
341  
HP  
AR  
SA  
TR  
LR  
RO  
CG  
RP  
FE  
MO  
IX  
Local Resection  
Road Line  
COGO  
Road Plus  
File Editor  
Monitoring  
Index  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Introduction  
11  
11  
12  
12  
15  
17  
19  
20  
21  
21  
CO  
General  
Installation in the PC  
Hardware and software required  
Rules for naming files  
Loading files into the TPS1000 instruments  
Loading system texts  
Loading application programs  
Licence code  
Solving problems  
General notes  
Units in this manual  
Preparation  
23  
23  
23  
23  
24  
24  
24  
25  
26  
26  
Settings  
Data exchange  
Using the program  
Instrument field setup  
Calling up the program  
Designation of keys  
Target eccentricity  
Orientation and Height Transfer  
Introduction  
27  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
34  
35  
35  
37  
37  
Target Point  
Point List  
Measure Mode  
Calculation  
More Information  
Plot  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Log file  
Resection  
39  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
45  
45  
47  
47  
Introduction  
Station Data  
Target Point  
Measure Mode  
Calculation  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Log File  
6
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tie Distance  
Introduction  
Measure Mode  
Results  
49  
49  
51  
53  
55  
55  
56  
57  
Configuration  
CO  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Log File  
Stakeout  
Introduction  
59  
59  
59  
60  
60  
62  
64  
66  
66  
68  
70  
72  
74  
75  
76  
77  
Search Point  
Coarse Positioning  
Line Offset  
Orthogonal  
Azimuth and Distance  
Stakeout  
Polar Stakeout  
Orthogonal Stakeout  
Stakeout with auxiliary points  
Stakeout from Coordinate Differences  
Select Stakeout Method  
Plot  
Configuration  
Log File  
Free Station  
79  
79  
80  
80  
81  
82  
83  
85  
87  
88  
88  
90  
90  
Introduction  
Station Data  
Target Point  
Point List  
Measure Mode  
Calculation  
More Information  
Plot  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Log File  
Reference Line  
Introduction  
93  
93  
Baseline Points  
95  
Determine Base Points  
Measure a Base Point  
Define Reference Line  
Results Reference Line  
Configuration  
95  
96  
98  
99  
101  
101  
103  
Configuration Editor  
Log File  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Height  
Introduction  
105  
105  
106  
108  
110  
Measure Base Point  
Measure Remote Point  
Configuration  
CO  
Hidden Point  
Introduction  
Configuration  
Measure Rod  
Results  
111  
111  
112  
114  
115  
Area (Computation of Area)  
Introduction  
117  
117  
118  
118  
120  
123  
124  
125  
125  
126  
127  
Measure Mode  
Straight line  
Arcs  
Calculation  
Plot  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Log File  
Sets of Angles  
Introduction  
129  
129  
130  
130  
131  
135  
140  
143  
143  
145  
Sets Menu  
Sets menu - view  
Measure Mode  
Calculate Mode  
Examples and used formulae  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Log File  
Traverse  
147  
147  
148  
148  
149  
153  
155  
156  
159  
160  
160  
161  
161  
163  
Introduction  
Traverse Menu  
Traverse menu  
New traverse  
Occupy station  
Traverse Point / Sideshot Point  
Close traverse  
Plot  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Multiple Measurement  
Log File  
8
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local Resection  
Introduction  
Station Data  
Target Points  
Calculation  
165  
165  
166  
167  
168  
169  
169  
170  
CO  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Dual-face Measurement  
Road line  
Introduction  
171  
171  
174  
175  
175  
176  
178  
178  
180  
183  
184  
188  
188  
190  
192  
192  
204  
Program concept  
Alignment  
Selection of files  
Checking files  
Program flow  
Chainage and centre-line offset  
Cross sections  
Stakeout  
X-section Check  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Log File  
Data format  
Hz-alignment  
The Road - Data Entry program  
COGO  
205  
205  
207  
208  
209  
212  
214  
216  
218  
221  
222  
227  
233  
237  
238  
241  
246  
Introduction  
Configuration  
Function selection (COGO Menu)  
Inverse (polar calculation)  
Traverse  
Defining direction by magnetic bearing  
Defining direction by Azimuth  
Defining horizontal distance  
Intersections  
Bearing-Bearing Intersection  
Bearing-Distance Intersection  
Distance-Distance Intersection  
Offsets  
Distance-Offset  
Orthogonal point calculation  
Three Point Arc  
Road Plus  
Introduction  
249  
249  
249  
249  
252  
252  
Alignment Definition  
Data Files  
Creating Data Files  
Program Overview  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Started  
Configuration  
253  
254  
256  
257  
257  
257  
259  
262  
263  
264  
264  
270  
273  
280  
280  
281  
282  
283  
284  
285  
289  
291  
291  
294  
296  
298  
300  
301  
Select Alignment Files  
Vertical Alignment File  
Horizontal Alignment File  
Cross Section/template File  
Cross Section Assignment File  
Station Equation File  
CO  
File Checking  
Stakeout Using Horizontal Offset  
Preparing for the example  
Select Template point and offset  
Stakeout and Record point  
Horizontal Offset Stake Out Summary  
Start ROADPLUS & Set Configuration Options  
Select Alignment Files  
Set offset value and select point to stakeout  
Stakeout the point  
Select new chainage  
Slope Staking  
Reference Point  
Data Formats  
Horizontal Alignment  
Vertical Alignment  
Cross Sections  
Cross Section Assignments  
Station Equations  
Log File  
File Editor  
Introduction  
303  
303  
303  
304  
305  
306  
311  
317  
321  
325  
329  
Creation of files  
Editing files  
Open file  
Coordinates  
Horizontal Alignment  
Vertical Alignment  
Template  
Station Equation  
Cross-section Assignment  
Monitoring  
333  
335  
336  
337  
338  
339  
340  
340  
Main menu  
Selecting points  
Measurement menu  
Selecting the points to be measured  
Timer selection  
Point measurement  
End monitoring  
Index  
341  
10  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
The electronic theodolites and total stations in the TPS  
System 1000 are equipped with programs for  
processing field data and control-point coordinates. The  
systems are therefore highly functional and classical  
survey tasks are simplified appreciably.  
General  
IN  
When delivered, the instruments are already equipped  
for the following standard applications:  
- Orientation and height transfer  
- Resection  
- Tie distance  
- Stakeout  
- Free-station survey (Licence code required)  
In addition, the following applications are delivered on  
diskette:  
- Reference line / building alignment  
- Remote height  
- Hidden points  
- Computation of area  
- Sets of angles  
- Traverse  
- Local resection  
- Roadline  
- File Editor  
- Road Plus  
- COGO  
- Monitoring  
This list is extended continuously. Find actual  
information in file README.TXT on diskette.  
The additional application programs can be loaded into  
the instrument, but can only be run as a demonstration  
version in which certain functions are disabled. Full  
functionality can be obtained with a licence code,  
available from your Leica agency, where you can also  
obtain information about the newest programs available  
in the ongoing applications-software development  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
project.  
All installation programs and applications are supplied  
on normal 3 1/2" diskettes.  
For optimal use of the programs and instruments read  
this manual carefully.  
IN  
Installation in the PC  
Hardware and software  
required  
The hardware and software used to transfer the  
individual program packages must meet the following  
requirements:  
• IBM-compatible PC, 386 or higher  
• 4 MB RAM  
• 3.5" floppy-disk drive  
• RS 232 interface, including interface cable for Leica  
survey instruments (stock no. 563625)  
• MS DOS 5.0 or higher  
• MS Windows 3.1  
Four diskettes are supplied with each instrument:  
• disk 1 = SYSTEM FIRMWARE  
• disk 2 = Programs and Languages  
• disk 3 = TPS-WORKBENCH  
• disk 4 = RCS 1000  
More information can be found in the file  
README.TXT on each diskette.  
Recommended installation procedure:  
1. TPS-WORKBENCH (disk 3)  
2. SYSTEM FIRMWARE (disk 1)  
3. Programs and languages (disk 2)  
4. RCS 1000 (disk 4)  
12  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On the diskette bearing the label  
TPS 1000/2000/5000  
TPS-WORKBENCH  
is the PC software needed to install applications or  
foreign-language texts on the TPS1000 instruments.  
IN  
Workbench TPS Tools 2.21  
Installation  
Installation TPS  
Install to:  
C:\LEICA.WB  
Continue  
Exit  
Installation Options:  
Directory...  
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
TPS Software Upload  
378 KB  
57 KB  
157 KB  
123 KB  
277 KB  
RCS 1000 Controller Upload  
TPS Code Development  
Software Radio Configuration  
TPS PC to MC / MC to PC  
Installation Drive:  
Space Required:  
Space Available:  
C:  
1697 KB  
...... KB  
Pause  
Exit F3  
The "WORKBENCH" program is installed in the PC  
by running the program "SETUP.EXE" under  
WINDOWS on the diskette. For further details, refer to  
the handbook or to the HELP file of WINDOWS.  
TPS-user just have to install the "TPS Softwae  
Upload".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The diskette bearing the label  
TPS 1000  
SYSTEM FIRMWARE  
contains the necessary system software for the TPS  
1000 instrument:  
IN  
• theodolite system software  
ATR system software  
• EDM system software  
The diskette bearing the label  
TPS 2000/5000  
SYSTEM FIRMWARE  
contains the necessary system software for the  
TPS2000/5000 instrument:  
• theodolite system software  
ATR system software  
• EDM system software  
The diskette bearing the label  
TPS 1000/2000/5000  
Programs and Languages  
contains:  
• all applications (both the standard ones and the  
additional ones),  
• the appropriate text files for the languages available.  
The text for the languages available are also included  
for the TPS1000 system software.  
The diskette bearing the label  
TPS 1000/2000/5000  
RCS 1000  
contains the remote control software:  
• for RCS 1000 based on CR233/333  
• for RCS 1000 based on GPC1  
14  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rules for naming files  
The files are named in accordance with the following  
rules:  
Application programs:  
?????VVV.PRG  
????? Maximum of 5 characters for name of  
application  
IN  
VVV  
PRG  
3 characters for version (release) number  
Identification tag for loadable application  
Text files:  
?????VVV.LSS  
????? identical name of relevant application  
VVV  
L
identical version (release) number of relevant  
application  
Identification tag for text file of application  
SS Identification tag for language  
SS =>  
EN English  
GE  
FR  
SP  
German  
French  
Spanish  
System texts:SYS?_VVV._SS  
SYS?_ Seven text files (SYS1_ ... SYS7_)  
VVV  
Version (release) number of system texts  
Identification tag for text file of system  
Identification tag for language  
SS  
SS =>  
GE  
FR  
SP  
German  
French  
Spanish  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After the installation is complete, you will find the  
following files in the subdirectory in your PC:  
Standard applications  
Application  
File name  
Text file  
Remarks  
IN  
All  
prtxtVVV.LEN  
prtxtVVV.LGE  
prtxtVVV.LFR  
prtxtVVV.LSP  
Texts common  
to all  
applications  
Orientation and  
height transfer  
ORI__VVV.PRG  
TIE__VVV.PRG  
ORI__VVV.LEN  
ORI__VVV.LGE  
ORI__VVV.LFR  
ORI__VVV.LSP  
English  
German  
French  
Spanish  
Tie distance  
Resection  
Stakeout  
TIE_VVV.LENetc.  
RESECVVV.PRG RESECVVV.LENetc.  
STAKEVVV.PRG STAKEVVV.LENetc.  
Additional applications  
Application  
File name  
Text file  
Stock no.  
663156  
Free-station survey FREE_VVV.PRG FREE_VVV.LEN etc.  
Reference line /  
REFL_VVV.PRG REFL_VVV.LEN etc.  
663198  
building alignment  
Hidden points  
Remote height  
Traverse  
HDNPTVVV.PR HDNPTVVV.LEN etc.  
REMHTVVV.PR REMHTVVV.LEN etc.  
TRAV_VVV.PRG TRAV_VVV.LEN etc.  
663213  
663200  
663197  
663196  
Computation of area AREA_VVV.PRG AREA_VVV.LEN etc.  
Sets of angles  
Local Resection  
Road Line  
SETS_VVV.PRG  
SETS_VVV.LEN etc.  
663199  
663267  
663216  
663217  
663218  
664401  
664411  
LRES_VVV.PRG LRES_VVV.LEN etc.  
ROADLVVV.PR ROADLVVV.LEN etc.  
File Editor  
Road Plus  
FILEDVVV.PRG  
FILEDVVV.LEN etc.  
RPLUSVVV.PRG RPLUSVVV.LEN etc.  
COGO_VVV.PRG COGO_VVV.LEN etc.  
COGO  
Monitoring  
MONIT222.PRG  
MONIT222.LEN etc.  
16  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading files into the  
TPS1000 instruments  
Applications, and system- and application texts, are  
loaded into the TPS1000 by means of the "TPS  
SOFTWARE UPLOAD" program.  
Use the interface cable 563 625 to connect the  
TPS1000 to the serial interface COM1 or COM2 on the  
PC.  
IN  
Start the "TPS SOFTWARE UPLOAD" program with a  
double-click from the WINDOWS program manager.  
Select the command "Sensor/Settings" and inspect the  
interface selected and the baud rate. The baud rate  
should be set to the maximum. The baud rate for the  
TPS1000 instrument is set automatically.  
TPS 1000 Settings  
COM-Port:  
OK  
COM1  
Cancel  
Baudrate  
4800  
Help  
9600  
19200  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switch the instrument off! Select the command "View  
Applications + System" to inspect the connection to the  
instrument. The instrument switches itself on again and  
establishes the connection. The display of the  
applications available on the instrument shows that the  
connection was successful. If it was not successful, read  
section "Solving problems".  
IN  
View Applications & System  
General  
Environment  
Applications  
Name  
Art.No.  
Licence Code  
Version  
Language  
FreeSt_Ori_Res  
V 2.20  
663156  
ENGLISH  
<none>  
TieDistance  
V 2.20  
663152  
ENGLISH  
<none>  
<none>  
Stakeout  
V 2.20  
663155  
ENGLISH  
Help  
Close  
18  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading system texts  
- Select the command "Transfer files" in the "Utilities"  
menu ,  
- Mark "System Language",  
- select relevant drive under "Directories",  
- select desired language under "Language" and  
- mark relevant file under "Components".  
IN  
Transfer  
Then press the  
key to start the transfer.  
The progress of the transfer is shown in a bar diagram.  
Transfer  
Component Type  
System Software  
Directories:  
Transfer  
i:\software\tps1000\V_2_20  
Cancel  
ü
System Language  
Application Program  
EDM/ATR Firmware  
i:\  
software  
tps1000  
V_2_20  
Settings ...  
Help  
Language:  
Drives:  
i:  
ENGLISH-T  
Components:  
System Language (ENGLISH-T Version 2.20)  
Afterwards, enter the language on the instrument (see  
section "Configuration" of "System" - user manual).  
The English system texts are part of the system software  
and can be neither loaded nor erased.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading application  
programs  
- Select the command "Transfer files" in the "Utilities"  
menu ,  
- Mark "Application Program",  
- select relevant drive under "Directories",  
- select desired language under "Language" and  
- mark desired program(s) under "Components".  
IN  
Transfer  
Then press the  
key to start the transfer.  
The progress of the transfer is shown in a bar diagram.  
Transfer  
Component Type  
System Software  
Directories:  
Transfer  
i:\software\tps1000\V_2_20  
Cancel  
System Language  
i:\  
software  
tps1000  
V_2_20  
Settings ...  
Help  
ü
Application Program  
EDM/ATR Firmware  
Language:  
Drives:  
i:  
ENGLISH-T  
Components:  
TPS-Application Area (V2.20)  
TPS-Application COGO (V2.20)  
TPS-Application FreeSt_Ori_Res (V2.20)  
TPS-Application HiddenPoint (V2.20)  
TPS-Application LocalRes (V2.20)  
TPS-Application RefLine (V2.20)  
It is absolutely necessary that the program files  
(*.prg) are be in the same directory as the language  
files (*.LSS) and the Prtxt220.LSS file.  
20  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When an additional application is first started up, a  
licence code is requested, so that the application will be  
fully functional. Without this licence code, you can run  
the applications as a demonstration version, but you will  
not be able to calculate and store the results.  
Licence code  
IN  
The licence code is available from your Leica agency,  
who will inform you about licence fees for additional  
applications. Details of the licence agreement are given  
in the registration card, which is a part of the "System"  
manual.  
To expedite formalities, please fill in a copy of the form  
at the end of this section and fax it to your local Leica  
agency.  
Solving problems  
1. Instrument does not switch on when "Utilities/View  
Applications + System..." option is selected.  
Inspect the cable connections and that the serial  
interface COM1 or COM2 has been set correctly.  
2. Instrument does not switch to "ON-LINE-MODE  
(GeoCOM)" mode when "Utilities/View  
Applications + System..." option is selected.  
Make sure that the instrument is switched off before  
the "Utilities/View Applications + System..." option  
is activated.  
3. Instrument does not switch to "ON-LINE-MODE  
(GeoCOM)" mode when "Utilities/View  
Applications + System..." option is selected;  
"MEASURE & RECORD" menu or another autostart  
application is displayed instead.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Carry out the following operations on the instrument:  
until main menu is displayed.  
or  
IN  
[CONF]  
Configuration  
[Autostart] Autoexec-application  
[LIST]  
and select "MAIN MENU"  
Switch off the instrument and start the data transfer  
process from the beginning.  
22  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Put crosses against the applications you require and send the form to your nearest  
Leica agency, which will process your order.  
Address of customer (please use Company stamp or write legibly)  
Name  
Company  
Leica Geosystems AG  
Geodesy  
CH-9435 Heerbrugg  
Street  
Zip code / City  
Country  
Telephone  
Telefax  
(Switzerland)  
Software Management Dept.  
Phone +41 71 727 36 81  
Fax +41 71 727 47 05  
Remarks  
(Company stamp, signature)  
Licence code for TPS 1000 applications  
Serial number TPS1000  
Name of application  
Free station survey  
Instrument type  
No. of application Licence code  
Remarks  
663156  
663196  
663197  
Computation of area  
Traverse  
Reference line/building  
alig.  
663198  
Sets of angles  
Remote height  
Hidden points  
Local resection  
Road Line  
663199  
663200  
663213  
663267  
663216  
663217  
663218  
664401  
664411  
File Editor  
Road Plus  
COGO  
Monitoring  
We confirm taking out  
a licence for the  
applications listed  
above, and we  
guarantee to pay the  
licence fees to Leica  
Geosystems AG.  
To be filled  
in by  
agency and  
forwarded  
to Leica  
Geosystems  
AG,  
Heerbrugg.  
(Company stamp, signature)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General notes  
Specifications within this manual always apply to the  
following units:  
Units in this manual  
Units of length:  
- in m (meters)  
GN  
- in addition, within brackets in ft (feet)  
Units of angle:  
- in ° ' "  
- in addition, within brackets in gon  
Units of temperature:  
- in °C  
- in addition, within brackets in °F  
All program sequences are based on a unified structure.  
The clearly-designed display with the function keys  
makes learning easy. Each program has a configuration  
dialog. In this dialog, the user can match program-  
specific parameters to changes in requirements and  
sequences. The various possibilities are described in the  
instructions for the individual programs.  
Preparation  
To avoid temporarily-stored information being lost  
when the TPS1000 automatically switches off after long  
periods of disuse, you should set the "sleep mode"  
instead of the automatic switchoff. For more  
Settings  
information, please refer to section "Fixed keys"  
("Power off, Sleep") of "System" - user manual.  
Each application takes over the settings (units,  
recording format, display format etc.) allocated to the  
appropriate user.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If required, these user settings must be defined in  
advance. For more information, please refer to section  
"User configuration" of "System" - user manual.  
Data exchange  
If the settings in an application are altered, these  
changed values will be taken over in the other  
GN  
applications also and in „Measure and record“. The  
settings affected are the station coordinates and the  
circle orientation, along with parameters such as the  
reflector constant, reflector height, and data for distance  
reduction. This data can be altered in every application.  
The measurement data is stored in the file selected.  
Using the program  
Instrument field setup  
The setup is called up in the main menu.  
To start with, the user profile and the file for storing  
measurement data can be selected in the start-up  
display.  
14:03  
SETUP\ START-UP DISPLAY  
Select user template & files  
User templ. :Polar(Standard)  
Rec. device :  
Memory Card  
Meas. file :1 FILE01.GSI  
Data file :2 FILE02.GSI  
QSET STN LIST  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
24  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The station number, the coordinates, the direction of the  
line of sight, and the instrument height, are all displayed  
The dialog enables station coordinates to be set or  
imported and also permits a direction to a tie point to be  
set.  
GN  
14:03  
SETUP\ STATION DATA  
Station no. :  
Inst.Height :  
Stat.Easting:  
Stat.Northg :  
Stat.Elev. :  
STATION 12  
1.634 m  
1010.567 m  
-34213.077 m  
345.655 m  
Hz  
:
390°35'58"  
REC Hz0 IMPOR αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Calling up the program  
The applications are called up in the main menu.  
Select the application required and  
confirm  
or  
alternatively type in the number which appears after the  
program name in the display.  
...  
14:03  
MAIN MENU: PROGRAMS  
Orientation & Ht. Transfer 00  
Resection  
01  
02  
03  
04  
Stakeout  
Tie Distance  
Free Station  
EXTRA CAL CONF DATA SETUP MEAS  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The effects of the fixed keys and of a few function keys are  
the same as their effects in "MEASURE AND RECORD".  
These keys are generally omitted from the descriptions  
of the applications and from the ON-LINE help.  
Designation of keys  
Continues sequence after input, measurements etc. have  
been concluded. If the measurement dialog is concluded  
GN  
with  
the measurement data will not be recorded.  
Erases incorrect alphanumeric input.  
Records in a pre-established format manually-entered  
coordinates, measurements or the results of  
calculations.  
"REC"  
Quits current dialog and calls up previous dialog.  
Changes and inputs to dialog are rejected and are not  
stored.  
Displays the second level of the function keys  
.
-
Calls ON-LINE help.  
Closes application.  
Calls up code input or code function in measurement  
dialog.  
If the reflector cannot be set up directly over the  
desired point, or if the point cannot be seen from the  
instrument, the function 'OFFS' may be used to make an  
offset measurement.  
Target eccentricity  
Previous to the input of the values for eccentricity, a  
distance must be measured to the reflector.  
For more information, please refer to section  
'Measurement & recording' of 'System'-user manual.  
26  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Orientation and Height Transfer  
This manual describes the "Orientation and Height  
Transfer" program of the TPS SYSTEM 1000  
theodolite series.  
Introduction  
0°00'00"  
OH  
H
N
Hz  
E
H
H  
N
E0  
H0  
N0  
E
The instrument must be set up on a known point. The  
program "ORIENTATION" calculates an angular  
correction for the instruments horizontal circle, so that  
0.0000 of the horizontal circle corresponds with grid  
north (Orientation correction), using reference points  
with known Easting and Northing.  
For simultaneous determination of the station elevation,  
height of instrument and height of reflector must  
already have been input and the elevation of the target  
points must be known.  
The program handles a maximum of 10 points.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Target Point  
Enter the target point number and height of the reflector  
.
14:03  
ORINT\ TARGET POINT  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height:  
12  
1.300 m  
CALC LIST <-- -->  
HELP CONF  
OH  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Run the calculation. Note, the  
after the first measurement.  
key will be assigned  
Entry of target points into a list as well as selecting  
points for further use.  
Displays the previous point from the list of points  
entered. Note that this key will not be available until  
there is at least one point in the list.  
Displays the next point in the list of points entered.  
Note that this key will not be available until there is at  
least one point in the list.  
Retrieve the coordinates of the target point from the  
selected file. For further information, please refer to  
dialog "IMPORT" described in the "System" - user  
manual.  
Start the "CONFIGURATION"  
28  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Point List  
Enter a maximum of 10 points. The same point can be  
retrieved several times.  
14:03  
ORINT\ POINT LIST  
Point 1  
Point 2  
Point 3  
Point 4  
Point 5  
Point 6  
:
:
:
:
:
:
1
2
3
4
5
6
OH  
Point 7  
Point 8  
Point 9  
Point10  
:
:
:
:
7
8
9
0
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Return to the dialog "Target Point".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
This dialog is similar to the TPS 1000’s basic "Measure  
Mode" dialog. Once a measurement is taken, the  
program will return to the dialog "Target Point" to  
acquire the next point for measuring.  
If the orientation correction can be calculated  
successfully from any of the first measurements, the  
Hz and V values are displayed for further entered  
target point. Motorized theodolites will automatically  
drive the telescope to the target point.  
OH  
14:03  
1
ORINT\ MEASURE MODE (GSI)  
Point no. :  
Hz  
V
:
:
216°55'50"  
71°16'20"  
Refl.Height :  
Slope Dist. :  
1.300 m  
385.231 m  
Hz  
:
-----  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device. Return to the dialog "Target Point".  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Return to the dialog "Target Point".  
Enter target data. For further information, please refer  
to chapter "Measure & Record" described in the  
"System" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" described in the "System" - user  
manual.  
Exit the program.  
Accept the measurement and return to the dialog  
"Target Point".  
30  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Calculates the orientation, the elevation and the  
respective standard deviations.  
Calculation  
14:03  
ORINT\ RESULTS <ROBUST>  
Station no.:  
10  
5
No. of Pts.:  
Inst.Height:  
1.635 m  
2134.234 m  
4723.365 m  
521.643 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
S.ORI S.HT STORE PLOT MORE  
OH  
Orientation :  
2°12'34"  
σElevation :  
0.010 m  
σOrient  
:
0°00'03"  
HELP LSQRS  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Station no  
No. of Pts  
: Point number assigned to the station  
: Number of points measured  
Inst.Height : Instrument Height  
Easting  
: Easting of the station entered.  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Northing of the station entered.  
: Calculated elevation of the station  
Orientation : Oriented direction  
σ Elevation : Standard deviation of the Elevation  
σ Orient  
: Standard deviation of the Orientation  
Set orientation on the instrument. Note that once this  
key has been pressed it will not be possible to  
execute more measurements.  
Set station elevation on the instrument. Note that once  
this key has been pressed it will not be possible to  
execute more measurements.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record the following results into the active file:  
WI 11  
WI 25  
WI 84  
WI 85  
WI 86  
WI 87  
WI 88  
Station Point Number  
Orientation correction  
Station Easting  
Station Northing  
Station Elevation  
Last reflector height used  
Instrument Height  
OH  
Sketch of the station and the reference points used.  
Show the results of individual measurements on the  
screen (see dialog "More Information").  
Measure more points. The program will recall the  
"TARGET POINT" dialog.  
Select between the "Robust" method and the "Variati-  
on" method.  
More Information  
Display the residuals of individual measurements. You  
can also disable points from the calculation of  
orientation or height as well as delete erroneous  
measured points.  
14:03  
2/10  
ORINT\ MORE INFORMATION  
Use for HT. : YES Status: ON  
Point no.  
Error flag :  
Hz  
Distance :  
:
Point01  
NONE  
0°00'03"  
0.050 m  
:
RECLC <-- --> MEAS DEL NO  
Height  
:
0.020 m  
1.555 m  
991.427 m  
1995.162 m  
402.466 m  
Refl.Height :  
Easting  
Northing  
Elevation  
:
:
:
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
32  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2/10  
: Sequence number of the current point  
and total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Use for Ht. : Use this measurement for height  
determination (YES/NO)  
Status  
: Use this measurement for calculation  
(ON/OFF).  
Point no  
: The target point number.  
OH  
Error Flag  
: Identified erroneous measurements.  
Possible values are:  
NONE  
HZ  
DIST  
HT  
measurement is OK  
horizontal angle error  
distance error  
height difference error  
The flags may also be combined, i.e.  
DIST + HZ  
Hz.  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured horizontal angle  
Distance  
Height  
Refl. Ht.  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured distance  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured height  
: Reflector height used for the target  
point  
Easting, Northing, Elevation: Target coordinates used.  
Recalculate the result.  
Scroll to the measurements of the previous point.  
Scroll to the measurements of the following point.  
Measure more points. Return to the dialog "Target  
Point".  
Delete a point from the set of measurements. You can  
now measure a new point in its place.  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Generates a plot showing the measurement  
configuration.  
Plot  
The station point is in the center and the top of the  
sketch shows the direction of grid north. The sketch is  
true in angular but not true in distances.  
Points are numbered sequentially in the order in witch  
they were measured.  
Points not used in the calculation are marked with a  
dotted line.  
OH  
14:03  
ORINT\  
PLOT  
2
1
3
5
4
RECLC  
HELP  
MEAS  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Recalculate the result and return to the dialog  
"CALCULATION RESULTS".  
Measure more points. The program will recall the  
"TARGET POINT" dialog.  
Toggle any point ON or OFF by pressing the numeric  
key corresponding to the sequence number of the point.  
...  
Note, that  
represents point 10  
Exit the program.  
34  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "TARGET-  
POINT" dialog.  
OH  
14:03  
ORINT\ CONFIGURATION  
Hz Ori Acc :  
Ht Acc TP :  
Posn Acc TP:  
Two faces :  
User Displ :  
0°00'32"  
0.0250 m  
0.0250 m  
NO  
NO  
Log File  
INFO  
:
OFF  
DFLT EDIT  
Log FlName :  
ORIENT.LOG  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor "sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Hz Ori Acc : Limit for the standard deviation of the  
orientation. The orientation is  
regarded as "error free", if the  
computed standard deviation of the  
orientation is within twice the entered  
value.  
Ht Acc TP  
: Height accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The height is regarded as "error free",  
if the computed standard deviation is  
within twice the entered value.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Posn Acc TP : Position accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The position is regarded as "error  
free", if the computed standard  
deviation is within twice the entered  
value.  
Two Faces  
: YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
OH  
User Disp  
: YES; the measured value indication is  
used from application "Measure and  
record".  
NO; the default indication is used for  
"Orientation and Height Transfer".  
Log File  
: ON, records measurements in a Log-  
File.The format is described on page  
37.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
Displays date and version.  
Set the values to default. Default values are shown in  
dialog on page 35.  
Exit the program.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "TARGET POINT".  
36  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dual-face Measurement  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
OH  
Log file  
If "Log File" is set to "ON" the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-  
file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record  
For each measurement, a record will be  
stored containing :  
Station coordinates  
station height,  
orientation correction  
standard deviations for  
height and  
orientation correction  
The residuals for:  
OH  
horizontal angles,  
heights and  
measured distances  
are also listed.  
Leica VIP Orientation + Ht. Transfer V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
Meas. file  
: TCM1100, Serial 412160, (not named)  
: User 1  
: FILE12.GSI  
Program Start  
: 09/04/1996 at 12:57  
Station no.  
: 2000  
E= -0.0006m N= -0.0002m ELV= 398.3961m hi= 1.6000m  
Using Robust Solution  
Station Elev.  
Ori.Corr.  
S.Dev. Elev.  
S.Dev. Orient.  
:
:
:
:
398.3929m  
40'36"  
0.0035m  
0°00'04"  
3 point(s) measured :  
## Point no.  
Hz  
Height  
0.0026m  
0.0044m  
-0.0070m  
Distance  
0.0020m  
0.0016m  
-0.0000m  
Error Flag  
NONE  
NONE  
1
2
3
500  
501  
502  
-0°00'55"  
-0°00'48"  
0°00'52"  
NONE  
Typical log file entry in the "Orientation and Height Transfer" program  
38  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resection  
This manual describes the "Resection" program of the  
TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
RE  
0°00'00"  
Pt2  
N
H
D2  
Hz1  
Pt1  
D1  
Hz2  
E0  
H0  
N0  
E
The program can be used to deduce the three-dimensio-  
nal coordinates for the instrument station and the  
orientation of the horizontal circle from measurements  
to 2 target points with know Easting and Northing. To  
compute the position coordinates, at least the distances  
and the directions for both points are necessary.  
For simultaneous determination of the station elevation,  
height of instrument and height of reflector must  
already have been input and the elevation of the target  
points must be known.  
The program allows measurement in single or dual-face  
mode.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter station point number and height of the instrument.  
Station Data  
14:03  
RESEC\ STATION DATA  
RE  
Station no. :  
Inst.Height :  
1
1.555 m  
αNUM  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Proceed to the dialog "Target PoinT"  
Start the "Configuration"  
40  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the target point number and height of the  
reflector.  
Target Point  
14:03  
RESEC\ TARGET POINT  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height:  
30  
RE  
1.300 m  
IMPOR αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Retrieve the coordinates of the point entered from the  
active file. For further information, please refer to  
dialog "Import" described in the "System" - user  
manual.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
This dialog is similar to the TPS System1000’s basic  
"Measure Mode" dialog. Once a measurement is taken,  
the program will return to the dialog "Target Point" to  
acquire the next point for measuring.  
RE  
14:03  
1
RESEC\ MEASURE MOD (GSI)  
Point no.  
:
Hz  
V
: 286°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
0.000 m  
----- m  
:
I
Refl.Height :  
Slope Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
αNUM  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device. Return to the dialog "TARGET  
POINT".  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Return to the dialog "TARGET POINT".  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of the "System" - user manual.  
Assigned with "aNUM" at point number input; assigned  
with "EDIT" at numerical input.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of the "System" - user manual.  
Exit the program.  
Accept the measurement and return to the dialog  
"TARGET POINT".  
42  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Calculation  
In this dialog the calculated station coordinates are  
shown with the orientation.  
14:03  
RESEC\CALCULATION RESULTS  
Station no.:  
1
No. of Pts.:  
2
RE  
Inst.Height:  
1.635 m  
2134.234 m  
4231.365 m  
580.643 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
SET  
STORE  
Orientation :  
2°12'34"  
0.003 m  
0.005 m  
0.005 m  
0°00'03"  
σEasting  
:
σNorthing :  
σElevation :  
σOrient  
HELP  
F1  
:
F4  
F5  
F6  
F2  
F3  
Station no  
No. of Pts  
: Station point number  
: Number of points measured  
Inst.Height : Instrument Height  
Easting  
: Calculated Easting (Y) for the station.  
: Calculated Northing (X) for the station.  
: Calculated elevation for the station  
Northing  
Elevation  
Orientation : Oriented direction  
σ Easting  
: Standard deviation of Easting  
σ Northing : Standard deviation of Northing  
σ Elevation : Standard deviation of the Elevation  
σ Orient  
: Standard deviation of the Orientation  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Set orientation and station coordinates on the  
instrument. Note that this key will end the program.  
Record the following results on the active recording  
device:  
RE  
WI 11  
WI 25  
WI 84  
WI 85  
WI 86  
WI 87  
WI 88  
Station Point Number  
Orientation correction  
Station Easting  
Station Northing  
Station Elevation  
Last rflector height used  
Instrument Height  
Exit the program.  
44  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
RE  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "STATION  
DATA" dialog.  
14:03  
RESEC\ CONFIGURATION  
Hz Ori Acc :  
Ht Acc TP :  
Posn Acc TP:  
Two Faces :  
User Displ :  
0°00'32"  
0.025 m  
0.025 m  
NO  
NO  
OFF  
Log File  
INFO  
:
DFLT EDIT  
Log FlName :  
RESECT.LOG  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Hz Ori Acc : Limit for the standard deviation of the  
orientation. The orientation is  
regarded as "error free", if the  
computed standard deviation of the  
orientation is within twice the entered  
value.  
Ht Acc TP  
: Height accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The height is regarded as "error free",  
if the computed standard deviation is  
within twice the entered value.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Posn Acc TP : Position accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The position is regarded as "error  
free", if the computed standard  
deviation is within twice the entered  
value.  
RE  
Two Faces  
: YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
Ben.Anzeige : YES; the measured value indication is  
used from application "Measure and  
record".  
NO; the default indication is used for  
the "Resection".  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in a log file as  
described on page 47.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
Displays date and version.  
Set the value to the default as described in dialog on  
page 45.  
Exit the program.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "STATION DATA".  
46  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged.  
These tolerances are used to avoid errors in target  
identification.  
If exceeded an error message will be displayed.  
Dual-face Measurement  
RE  
If "Log File" is set to "ON" the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
Record  
For each measurement, a record will  
be stored containing :  
Station coordinates and orientation  
correction, standard deviation for  
Easting, Northing, Height of station  
and orientation correction.  
The residuals for horizontal angles,  
heights and measured distances are  
also listed.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Resection V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
: TCM1100, Serial 412160, (not named)  
: User 1  
Meas. file  
Program Start  
: FILE12.GSI  
: 09/04/1996 at 12:52  
RE  
Using Least-Squares Solution  
Station no.  
: 2000  
E= -0.0011m N= -0.0006m ELV= 398.3951m hi= 1.6000m  
Ori.Corr.  
;
:
:
:
:
240°50'51"  
0.0003m  
0.0003m  
0.0047m  
0°00'49"  
S.Dev. East  
S.Dev. North  
S.Dev. Elev.  
S.Dev. Orient.  
2 point(s) measured :  
## Point no.  
Hz  
-0°00'55"  
-0°00'18"  
Height  
0.0047m  
-0.0047m  
Distance  
0.0001m  
0.0002m  
Error Flag  
NONE  
NONE  
1
2
500  
501  
Typical log file entry in the "Resection" program  
48  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tie Distance  
This manual describes the "Tie Distance" program of  
the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
The program calculates the length and azimuth of a line  
connecting two points.  
Polygonal or Radial methods can be used as shown in  
the illustrations.  
Introduction  
TD  
The data for the points can either be measured or  
retrieved from the selected file. Measured points and  
points retrieved from the selected file can be used  
together in the calculations, if the station coordinates  
and orientation are set correctly.  
In Polygonal Mode, the program will calculate the  
distance between the last two points measured (eg. Pt3 -  
Pt4).  
0°00'00"  
Pt2  
Pt3  
Hz2  
Pt1  
N
H
Hz1  
Hz3  
Pt4  
Slope Dist 1  
Slope Dist 2  
Slope Dist 3  
E0  
N0  
E
Polygonal Mode  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Radial Mode, the program will calculate the distance  
between the last point measured (called a Radial Point)  
(Pt2, Pt3 ...) and a fixed Center Point (Pt1).  
0°00'00"  
Pt2  
0°00'00"  
Pt1  
Pt3  
Hz3  
Hz2  
Hz1  
H
N
Pt4  
TD  
Slope Dist 1  
Slope Dist 2  
Slope Dist 3  
E0  
N0  
E
Radial Mode  
Toggling between Polygonal and Radial Mode at any  
time while working is possible.  
50  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
This dialog is used in accordance with the settings of  
the system function "Measure & Record" or according  
to the dialog shown below.  
14:03  
546  
1.654 m  
230°45'23"  
4°52'35"  
----- m  
----- m  
TIED\ FIRST POINT  
TD  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
Hz  
V
:
:
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT IMPOR  
Easting  
:
:
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Northing  
Elevation :  
HELP CONF  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The input for the start point is only possible after the  
program start or with the function  
"RADIAL MODE".  
in the dialog  
For all following points the program requests (NEXT  
POINT).  
The dialog for the following points is identical with  
dialog above, except for the title.  
Simultaneously measure and record in the active file.  
Proceed with the dialog "NEXT POINT". If the second  
point has already been measured, the program will  
proceed to the "RESULT" dialog.  
Measure a distance. Record the measurement in the  
active file and proceed with the dialog "NEXT  
POINT". If the second point has already been  
measured, the program will proceed to the "RESULT"  
dialog.  
Measure the distance. Accept the measurement without  
recording. If the second point has already been  
measured, the program will proceed with the  
"RESULT" dialog.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the target data.  
For further information refer to chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "System" - user manual.  
Import target coordinates.  
For further information, please refer to chapter "Setup"  
of "System" - user manual.  
Start the "Configuration Editor".  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "System" - user manual.  
TD  
Exit the program  
52  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This dialog shows the results computed from the last  
two points, which can be measured or retrieved from  
the active file. The same results are calculated for both  
methods.  
Results  
Using "Polygon Mode" the calculations are always  
based on the last two points, where as the "Radial  
Mode" always uses the first point as a reference point.  
TD  
14:03  
12  
TIED\ RADIAL MODE  
Center Pt. :  
Radial Pt. :  
13  
Hori.Dist. :  
4.567 m  
342°52'35"  
Azimuth  
:
:
Height  
2.543 m  
4.946 m  
Slope Dist.:  
N.PKT N.ZEN STORE  
POLYG  
Easting  
:
22.432 m  
50.083 m  
Northing :  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Center Pt.  
Radial Pt.  
Hori.Dist  
: Point number of the center point  
: Point number of the radial point  
: Horizontal distance between the two  
points  
Azimuth  
: Azimuth from point 1 to point 2  
Height  
: Height difference between point 1 and  
point 2 (H2 - H1).  
Slope Dist  
: Slope distance between the two points  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Easting  
: Difference in Easting between point 1  
and point 2 (E2 - E1).  
The grid coordinates are only valid for  
oriented instruments set up on a  
known point.  
Northing : Difference Northing between point 1  
and point 2 (N2 - N1).  
Note, the grid coordinates are only  
relevant for oriented instruments set  
up on a known point.  
TD  
Return to the dialog "NEXT POINT" and measure the  
next point.  
Delete previous inputs. Proceed with the dialog "FIRST  
POINT" to enter a new reference point. This function is  
available for "RADIAL MODE" only.  
Record the following results in the active file:  
WI 11  
Point number of point 2 or radial point  
number  
WI 25  
WI 35  
WI 37  
Azimuth from point1 to point 2  
Horizontal distance  
Height difference between point 1 and  
point 2  
WI 39  
WI 79  
Slope distance  
Point number of point 1 or center point  
number  
Toggle between Radial/Polygon Mode.  
54  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
TD  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "FIRST  
POINT" dialog.  
14:03  
NO  
TIED\ CONFIGURATION  
Two Faces :  
User Disp. :  
NO  
Log File  
:
OFF  
Log FlName :  
TIEDIST.LOG  
DFLT YES  
INFO  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Two Faces  
User Disp.  
: Set YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
: YES to use the measurement display  
set in the application "Measure &  
Record".  
Set NO to use the "Tie Distance"  
default display.  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in the Log File  
according to the format described on  
page 57.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Set the values to default. Default values are displayed in  
dialog on page 55.  
Exit the program.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "MEASURE MODE".  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon)) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
Dual-face Measurement  
TD  
56  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
TD  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
Record  
For each measurement, a record will  
be stored containing :  
Point No 1, Point No. 2, Hori. Dist.,  
Azimuth, Height, Slope Dist.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Tie Distance V 2.10  
Instrument  
User Templ.  
Meas. File  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 412160, (not named)  
User 1  
FILE12.GSI  
Program Start  
09/04/1996 at 01:13  
Station no.  
Point No.1  
Point No.2  
:
1151  
E= 0.0000m N= 0.0000m ELV= 400.0000m hi= 0.0000m  
:
:
1020  
E= -31.2368m N= -0.2083m ELV= 400.0626m  
1030  
E= -30.5679m N= -17.8404m ELV= 403.1198m  
TD  
Point no.1  
Point no.2  
Hori.Dist.  
Azimuth  
:
:
:
:
1020  
1030  
17.6448m  
197°58'40"  
Height  
Slope dist.  
:
:
3.0572m  
17.9077m  
Point No.2  
:
1040  
E= -57.7040m N= -0.4265m H= 400.1028m  
Point No. 1  
Point No.2  
Hori.Dist.  
Azimuth  
:
:
:
:
1030  
1040  
32.2430m  
336°32'14"  
Height  
Slope dist.  
:
:
-3.0170m  
32.3839m  
Typical log file entry in the "Tie Distance" program  
(Polygonal Mode)  
58  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout  
This manual describes the "STAKEOUT" program of  
the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series. The program  
allows points with known coordinates to be placed in  
the field.  
Introduction  
"STAKEOUT" requires the instrument to be set up on  
a known point with the instrument oriented. The station  
point can be determined also with the programs "FREE  
STATION" and "RESECTION".  
The stakeout points can either be retrieved from the  
selected file or entered manually.  
The program permits selection of either 2D or 3D  
stakeout modes.  
SO  
The "SEARCH POINT" dialog informs about the active  
recording device, the active file for data storage and the  
present point/code.  
Search Point  
14:03  
STAKE\ SEARCH POINT  
Define stakeout point  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
Pkt/Code  
:
:
FILE01.GSI  
4
INPUT  
SEARC αNUM  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manually enter the stakeout point. The TPS 1000  
manual input dialog will appear.  
Initiate a search of the point in the database.  
Allows program configuration.  
or  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Coarse Positioning  
Once the coordinates of the stakeout point have been  
acquired, the program proceeds to "Coarse  
Positioning". This option is available to direct the prism  
from the previous point placed to the next.  
The "Coarse Positioning" calculates various  
displacements, depending on the method selected.  
Displacements are computed between the last point  
placed and the actual stakeout point selected. For more  
information refer to chapter "Stakeout".  
SO  
Line Offset  
The stakeout values of each point are computed in  
relation to the base formed by the last two points.  
If the elevation is known for the point to be staked out,  
the height difference in relation to the last base point  
(Pt2), is displayed. In particular, this method is  
advantageous for long objects (traffic routes). Values  
for positioning are only displayed after two stakeout  
points.  
Pt1  
Pt2  
H
N
Line  
Pt3  
Offset  
E0  
Height  
N0  
E
Pt3 ... point to be staked  
60  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
STAKE\ LINE OFFSET  
Target no. :  
CURB  
Azimuth  
Hz  
:
:
:
:
:
90°10'02"  
98°34'45"  
Line  
Offset  
Height  
4.105 m  
1.250 m  
0.340 m  
STAKE  
HELP METHD  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target no  
Azimuth  
: Number of the point to be staked.  
SO  
: Azimuth from the station to the point  
to be staked.  
Hz  
: Present theodolite direction. Note, if  
the instrument is oriented and the  
azimuth and Hz angle are  
corresponding, the instrument is  
pointing to the point to be staked.  
Line  
: Distance along the line defined by the  
last two points staked  
Offset  
Height  
: Orthogonal offset from the defined  
line  
: Height difference from the last point  
staked.  
Proceed to "STAKEOUT". Motorized theodolites can  
drive the telescope to the horizontal and vertical  
direction of the point to be placed.  
or  
Change stakeout method. For more information refer to  
chapter "Select Stakeout Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Orthogonal  
Setting out values are computed as orthogonal  
coordinates to the baseline between instrument station  
and prism. If the elevation is also known, H is given in  
relation to the last prism - point measured.  
Note, data will be displayed if there is at least one point  
measured.  
Pt1  
N
H
point to be staked  
SO  
−∆L  
H  
E0  
N0  
E
14:03  
STAKE\ORTHOGONAL STAKE  
Target no. :  
CURB  
Azimuth  
Hz  
:
:
:
:
:
90°10'02"  
98°34'45"  
L  
4.105 m  
Q  
1.250 m  
0.340 m  
Height  
STAKE  
HELP METHD  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target no.  
Azimuth  
: Number of the point to be staked.  
: Azimuth from the station to the point  
to be staked.  
62  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hz Angle  
: Present theodolite direction. Note, if  
the instrument is oriented and the  
azimuth and Hz angle are  
corresponding, the instrument is  
pointing to the point to be staked.  
L and Q in relation to the baseline:  
last stakeout point - instrument station.  
L  
: In-line distance L is positive for  
points further than the last prism  
position measured.  
Q  
: Distance perpendicular to the  
baseline. Q is positive for points on  
the right of the baseline.  
SO  
Height  
: Height difference from the last point  
measured.  
Proceed to "STAKEOUT". Motorized theodolites can  
drive the telescope to the horizontal and vertical  
direction of the point to be placed.  
or  
Change stakeout method.  
For more information refer to chapter "Select Stakeout  
Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data.  
For more information to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Azimuth and Distance  
This method defines the point to be staked in terms of  
the azimuth and distance from the theodolite station to  
the point.  
0°00'00"  
Azimuth  
N
H
point to be  
staked  
SO  
E0  
N0  
E
14:03  
STAKE\AZIMUTH & DISTANCE  
Target no. :  
CURB  
90°10'02"  
98°34'45"  
Azimuth  
Hz  
:
:
Slope Dist. :  
Horiz.Dist. :  
4.105 m  
4.021 m  
0.340 m  
Height  
:
STAKE  
HELP METHD  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target No.  
Azimuth  
: Number of the point to be staked.  
: Azimuth from the station to the point  
to be staked.  
Hz  
: Present theodolite direction.  
Note, if the instrument is oriented  
and the azimuth and Hz angle are  
corresponding, the instrument is  
pointing to the point to be staked.  
64  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Slope Dist  
Horiz. Dist  
: Slope distance from the instrument  
station to the stakeout point.  
: Horizontal distance from the  
instrument station to the stakeout  
point.  
Height  
: Height difference from the instrument  
station to the stakeout point.  
Proceed to "STAKEOUT". Motorized theodolites can  
drive the telescope to the horizontal and vertical  
direction of the point to be placed.  
or  
SO  
Change stakeout method.  
For more information refer to chapter "Select Stakeout  
Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout  
Points must have known coordinates. Various methods  
can be used, depending on the Stakeout Method set.  
Motorized instruments can drive the telescope to the  
horizontal and vertical direction of the point to be  
staked. For more information refer to chapter "Select  
Stakeout Method".  
Polar Stakeout  
After the first distance has been measured, the  
differences between calculated and measured direction  
and between calculated and measured horizontal  
distance are displayed. If the elevation of the point to be  
staked is available, the height difference between the  
last measured reflector and the point to be staked is  
shown together with the measured elevation of the  
reflector point.  
SO  
point to be staked  
Dist  
N
H
Hz  
Pt1  
E0  
H  
N0  
E
Values for Hz and D will be updated each time a new  
distance is measured.  
14:03  
0025  
STAKE\ POLAR STAKEOUT  
Target no. :  
Hz  
:
90°10'02"  
Dist  
:
4.567 m  
Height  
Elevation  
:FILL  
:
0.102 m  
32.543 m  
ALL DIST REC TARGT POSIT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
66  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Target no.  
: Point number of the point to be  
staked.  
Hz  
: Difference in Hz circle reading  
between the actual horizontal  
direction and the calculated direction.  
Dist  
: Difference in horizontal distance  
between the measured and calculated  
distance.  
Height  
: Difference in height between the  
measured reflector point and the  
stakeout point, expressed both  
numerically and as CUT/FILL.  
SO  
Elevation  
: Elevation of the measured target point.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "System" - user manual.  
Re-position the telescope on the target. Note, this  
function is only available for motorized theodolites.  
Change stakeout method. For more information refer to  
chapter "Select Stakeout Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information refer to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
Acquire the next point to stake.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Orthogonal offsets are computed using the baseline  
between the last measured point and the instrument  
station.  
Orthogonal Stakeout  
After the first distance measurement, the transverse and  
longitudinal differences are displayed. If the elevation  
of the stakeout point is available, the height difference  
between the measured reflector and the point to be  
staked is shown, and also the measured elevation of the  
reflector point.  
Q  
point to be staked  
N
D  
H
SO  
Pt1  
H  
E0  
N0  
E
Values for Q and D will be updated each time a new  
distance is measured.  
14:03  
CURB  
0.012 m  
4.567 m  
0.102 m  
32.543 m  
STAKE\ORTHOGONAL STAKE  
Target no. :  
Q  
:
D  
:
Height  
Elevation  
:FILL  
:
ALL DIST REC TARGT POSIT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target no.  
: Point number of the point to be  
staked.  
Q  
: Transversal displacement of the  
reflector. Positive in sign if point is  
right.  
68  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D  
: Longitudinal displacement of the  
reflector. Positive in sign if stakeout  
point is further away from station.  
Height  
: Difference in height between  
measured reflector point and the  
stakeout point. Positive in sign if  
stakeout point is higher than the  
reflector position.  
Elevation  
: Elevation of the measured reflector  
point.  
SO  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "System" - user manual.  
Re-position the telescope on the target. Note, this  
function is only available for motorized theodolites.  
Change stakeout method. For more information refer to  
chapter "Select Stakeout Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information refer to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
Acquire the next point to stake.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The stakeout method computes values for points which  
cannot be sighted directly.  
Stakeout with auxiliary  
points  
Measure to the auxiliary point Pt1. The distance "Dist  
1" and angle "Hz angle 1" to the stakeout point are  
computed. Likewise proceed for auxiliary point Pt2.  
The stakeout point can be set out using the 2 calculated  
distances and/or angles from auxiliary points Pt1 and  
Pt2.  
The program automatically updates both distance and  
angle values whenever a new point is measured. The  
previous point Pt2 becomes Pt1 and the new point Pt  
becomes Pt2.  
SO  
Note, the auxiliary point to be measured will be marked  
with an asterisk (*).  
Pt2  
point to be  
staked  
H
N
Hz2  
Hz1  
Dist2  
Pt1  
Dist1  
E0  
N0  
E
14:03  
STAKE\ AUXILIARY POINTS  
Target no. :  
Hz Angle 1 :*  
CURB  
90°01'02"  
4.567 m  
Dist 1  
:*  
Hz Angle 2 :  
150°22'34"  
Dist 2  
:
2.973 m  
Height  
:CUT  
-0.102 m  
ALL DIST REC TARGT POSIT  
HELP METHD  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target no  
: Point number of the point to be  
staked.  
70  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hz Angle 1 : Angle from the first auxiliary point to  
the stakeout point.  
Dist 1  
: Distance from the first auxiliary point  
to the stakeout point.  
Hz Angle 2 : Angle from the second auxiliary point  
to the stakeout point.  
Dist 2  
: Distance from the second auxiliary  
point to the stakeout point.  
Height  
: Difference in height between the last  
measured reflector point and the  
stakeout point. Positive in sign if  
stakeout point is higher than the  
reflector position.  
SO  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "System" - user manual.  
Re-position the telescope on the target. Note, this  
function is only available for motorized theodolites.  
Change stakeout method. For more information refer to  
chapter "Select Stakeout Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information refer to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
Acquire the next point to stake.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout from Coordinate  
Differences  
After the first distance measurement, the displacements  
along the grid coordinate axes are displayed. If the  
elevation of the point to be staked is available, the  
height difference between the measured reflector and  
the stakeout point is shown as well as the measured  
elevation of the reflector point.  
Pt1  
H
N
H  
SO  
point to be  
staked  
Northing  
E0  
Easting  
N0  
E
Values for E and N will be updated each time a new  
distance is measured.  
14:03  
STAKE\ GRID COORDINATES  
Target no. :  
Easting :  
Northing :  
Ta0025  
0.101 m  
0.567 m  
-0.102 m  
32.543 m  
Height  
: CUT  
Elevation :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT POSIT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Target no.  
: Point number of the point to be  
staked.  
Easting  
: Displacement of the reflector along  
the East-coordinate axis.  
Northing : Displacement of the reflector along  
the North-coordinate axis.  
72  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Height  
: Difference in height between the  
measured reflector point and the  
stakeout point. Positive in sign if  
stakeout point is higher than the  
reflector position.  
Elevation  
: Elevation of the measured reflector  
point.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
SO  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "System" - user manual.  
Re-position the telescope on the target. Note, this  
function is only available for motorized theodolites.  
Change stakeout method. For more information refer to  
chapter "Select Stakeout Method".  
Generate a plot of the stakeout data. For more  
information refer to chapter "Plot".  
Exit the program.  
Acquire the next point to stake.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select Stakeout Method  
Select the stakeout method in any stakeout dialog.  
14:03  
LINE OFFSET  
STAKE\ SELECT METHOD  
Coarse Meth :  
Stakeout M. :POLAR STAKEOUT  
3D Stakeout. :  
Position  
Hght. Shift :  
ON  
2D  
:
0.000 m  
POLAR ORTHO AUX GRID LIST  
HELP  
SO  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Coarse Meth  
:
Select the method for "COARSE POSITIONING":  
NONE  
no static method used  
LINE OFFSET  
ORTHOGONAL  
see chapter "Line Offset"  
see chapter "Orthogonal"  
AZIMUTH & DISTAN see chapter "Azimuth and  
Distance"  
Choosing NONE, the program will automatically  
proceed to the selected "STAKEOUT METHOD" and  
bypass the "COARSE POSITIONING" method after  
you selected a new stakeout point.  
Stakeout M. :  
Select the method for "STAKEOUT":  
POLAR STAKEOUT  
see chapter "Polar  
Stakeout"  
ORTHOGONAL STAKE see chapter "Orthogonal  
Stakeout"  
AUXILIARY POINTS  
see chapter "Stakeout with  
auxiliary points"  
GRID COORDINATES see chapter "Stakeout from  
Coordinate Differences"  
74  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3D Stakeout : ON for 3D stakeout,  
OFF for 2D stakeout.  
Position  
: Select positioning method. (Motorized  
instruments only):  
Off Automatic positioning off  
2D  
Positioning of the horizontal  
drive  
Positioning vertical and  
horizontal drive  
3D  
Hght. Shift : All heights are changed by this  
amount. The value can be changed  
only when you are in this dialog.  
SO  
Plot  
A plot is generated of the stakeout situation with a list  
of the numeric values, corresponding to the  
"STAKEOUT METHOD".  
Note, below a typical plot is shown using the coordinate  
"STAKEOUT METHOD".  
14:03  
STAKE\  
E PS  
N  
PLOT  
E : 0.024 m  
N : 0.012 m  
R
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "SEARCH  
POINT" dialog.  
14:03  
ON  
STAKE\ CONFIGURATION  
3D Stake  
Log File  
:
:
OFF  
STAKEOUT.LOG  
Log FlName :  
INFO  
HELP  
DFLT OFF  
SO  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
3D Stake  
: ON  
for 3-dimensional stakeout.  
Note the program will not perform 3D  
stakeout if no elevation is available  
for the point to be staked.  
OFF  
for 2-dimensional stakeout.  
Note that there will be no difference in  
height displayed.  
Log File  
: OFF  
no recording in a Log file  
SHORT reduce recording in a Log  
file  
LONG detailed recording in a Log  
file  
Display software-version  
Set the value to default. (3D stake = ON) .  
76  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exit the program.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "SEARCH POINT".  
Log File  
If "Log File" is set to "ON" the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
SO  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
Record  
SHORT  
recording of design  
coordinates, setout height and height  
difference in the log file.  
LONG  
recording of design  
coordinates, setout coordinates und  
differences of coordinates in the log  
file.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Stakeout V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
Meas. file  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 412160, (not named)  
User 1  
FILE12.GSI  
Program Start  
09/04/1996 at 01:18  
Station no.  
:
3000  
E= 21.016m N= 64.666m  
ELV= 420.467m hi= 1.700m  
Point no.  
Design  
Staked  
Deltas  
:
:
:
:
1152, Hght. Shift = 0.000m  
E= 21.602m N= 62.184m ELV= 420.115m  
E= 21.606m N= 62.166m ELV= 420.355m hr= 1.500m  
dO= -0.004m dN= 0.018m dELV= -0.240m  
SO  
Typical log file entry in the "STAKEOUT" program  
78  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Free Station  
This manual describes the "FREE STATION" program  
of the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
FS  
Pt2  
Pt1  
N
H
Pt3  
E0  
N0  
E
This program can be used to deduce the three-dimensio-  
nal coordinates for the instrument station and the  
horizontal orientation of the from measurements to a  
maximum of 10 target points.  
For simultaneous determination of the station elevation,  
height of instrument and height of reflector must  
already have been input and the elevation of the target  
points must be known.  
The program allows measurement in single or dual-face  
mode.  
Directions to target points can be determined, as can  
any combination of direction and distance. To compute  
the position coordinates, at least three elements (2  
directions and 1 distance) are necessary.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter station point number and height of the instrument.  
Station Data  
14:03  
FREST\ STATION DATA  
Station no.:  
Inst.Height:  
1
1.555 m  
αNUM  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
FS  
Proceed to define the target points.  
Start the "CONFIGURATION"  
Alpha-numerical/numerical input.  
Target Point  
Enter the target point number and height of the  
reflector.  
14:03  
FREST\ TARGET POINT  
Station no.:  
Refl.Height:  
1
1.555 m  
CALC LIST <-- -->  
HELP  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Run the calculation. Note, the  
key will be  
assigned after sufficient measurements were taken to  
calculate a position.  
80  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entry of target points into a list as well as selecting  
points for further use.  
Displays the previous point from the list of points you  
entered. Note that this key will not be available until  
there is at least one point in the list.  
FS  
Displays the next point in the list of points you entered.  
Note that this key will not be available until there is at  
least one point in the list.  
Retrieve the coordinates of the target point from the  
active file. For further information, please refer to  
dialog "IMPORT" described in the "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Alpha-numerical/numerical input.  
Enter a maximum of 10 points. The same point can be  
retrieved several times.  
Point List  
The same point number can be used several times  
without new input.  
14:03  
TAR01  
TAR02  
TAR03  
TAR04  
TAR05  
TAR06  
FREST\ POINT LIST  
Point 1  
Point 2  
Point 3  
Point 4  
Point 5  
Point 6  
Point 7  
Point 8  
Point 9  
Point10  
TAR07  
TAR08  
TAR09  
TAR10  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Return to the dialog "Target Point".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
This dialog is similar to the TPS System 1000’s basic  
"MEASURE MODE" dialog. Once a measurement is  
taken, the program will return to the dialog "DEFINE  
POINT" to acquire the next point for measuring.  
If the station coordinates can be calculated successfully  
from the first few measurements, the Hz and V  
values are displayed for further entered target points.  
Motorized theodolites will automatically drive the  
telescope to the target point.  
14:03  
12  
FREST\MEASURRE MODE (GSI)  
Point no. :  
Hz  
V
:
:
286°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
FS  
Refl.Height :  
Slope Dist. :  
1.500 m  
22.039 m  
Hz  
:
-----  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device. Return to the dialog "TARGET  
POINT".  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Return to the dialog "TARGET POINT".  
Enter target data. For further information, please refer  
to chapter "Measure & Record" described in the  
"System" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" described in the "System" - user  
manual.  
Exit the program.  
Accept the measurement and return to the dialog  
"TARGET POINT".  
82  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Calculates the 3D station coordinates and orientation as  
well as the standard deviation of the results.  
Calculation  
14:03  
FREST\ RESULTS <L.SQRS>  
Station no.:  
1
No. of Pts :  
6
FS  
Inst.Height:  
1.635 m  
2134.234 m  
4231.365 m  
580.643 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
SET  
STORE PLOT MORE  
Orientation :  
2°12'34"  
σEasting  
:
0.003 m  
σNorthing :  
0.005 m  
0.005 m  
σElevation :  
σOrient  
:
0°00'03"  
Calc Scale :  
YES  
Scale  
:
0.999956  
HELP ROBST  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Station no  
No. of Pts  
: Point number assigned to the station  
: Number of points measured  
Inst.Height : Instrument Height  
Easting  
: Calculated Easting for the station  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Calculated Northing for the station  
: Calculated Elevation for the station  
Orientation : Oriented direction  
σ Easting  
: Standard deviation of Easting  
σ Northing : Standard deviation of Northing  
σ Elevation : Standard deviation of the Elevation  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
σ Orient  
: Standard deviation of the Orientation  
Calc Scale  
: YES scale factor is calculated,  
NO scale factor is not calculated  
Scale  
: The scale factor of the free station  
calculation.  
Note that the scale is not shown if  
set to NO.  
Set orientation and station coordinates on the  
instrument. Note that this key will end the program.  
FS  
Record the following results on the active recording  
device:  
WI 11  
WI 25  
WI 84  
WI 85  
WI 86  
WI 87  
WI 88  
Station Point Number  
Orientation correction  
Station Easting  
Station Northing  
Station Elevation  
Last reflector height used  
Instrument Height  
Sketch of the station and the reference points used.  
Show the results of individual measurements on the  
screen (see dialog "More Information").  
Measure more points. The program will recall the  
"TARGET POINT" dialog.  
Select between the "Robust" method and the "Variati-  
on" method  
Exit the program.  
84  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display the residuals of individual measurements. You  
can also disable points from the calculation of position  
or height as well as delete erroneous measured points.  
More Information  
14:03  
9/10  
FREST\MEHR INFORMATIONEN  
FS  
Use for Ht :YES Status: ON  
Point no.  
Error Flag :  
Hz  
Distance :  
:
12  
NONE  
:
0°00'03"  
0.050 m  
RECLC <-- --> MEAS DEL NO  
Height  
:
0.020 m  
1.555 m  
991.427 m  
1995.162 m  
402.466 m  
Refl.Height :  
Easting  
Northing  
Elevation  
:
:
:
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
9/10  
: Sequence number of the current point  
and total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Use for Ht. : Use this measurement for height  
determination (YES/NO)  
Status  
: Use this measurement for calculation  
(ON/OFF).  
Point no  
: The target point number.  
Error Flag  
: Identified erroneous measurements.  
Possible values are:  
NONE  
HZ  
DIST  
HT  
measurement is OK  
horizontal angle error  
distance error  
height difference error  
The flags may also be combined, i.e.  
DIST + HZ  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hz.  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured Hz. angle  
Distance  
Height  
Refl. Ht.  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured distance  
: Difference between calculated and  
measured height  
: Reflector height used for that target  
point  
Easting, Northing, Elevation : Target coordinates  
used.  
FS  
Recalculate the result.  
Scroll to the measurements of the previous point.  
Scroll to the measurements of the following point.  
Measure more point. Return to dialog "TARGET  
POINT".  
Delete a point from the set of measurements . You can  
now measure a new point in its place.  
Exit the program.  
86  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Plot  
Generates a plot showing the measurement  
configuration. The station point is in the center and the  
top of the sketch shows the direction of Grid north. The  
sketch is true in angular but not true in distances. Points  
are numbered sequentially in the order in which they  
were measured. Points not used in the calculation are  
marked with a dotted line.  
FS  
14:03  
FREST\  
PLOT  
4
2
1
3
5
RECLC  
HELP  
MEAS  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Recalculate the solution and return to the dialog  
"CALCULATION RESULTS" (see page 83).  
Measure more points. The program will recall the  
"TARGET POINT" dialog. (see page 80).  
Toggle any point ON or OFF by pressing the numeric  
key corresponding to the sequence number of the point.  
...  
Note, that  
represents point 10.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "STATION  
DATA" dialog.  
14:03  
FREST\ CONFIGURATION  
Hz Ori Acc :  
Ht Acc TP :  
Posn Acc TP:  
Two Faces :  
User Displ.:  
0°00'32"  
0.0250 m  
0.0250 m  
NO  
NO  
FS  
Log File  
INFO  
:
OFF  
DFLT EDIT  
Log FlName :  
FREE_STA.LOG  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Hz Ori Acc : Limit for the standard deviation of the  
orientation. The orientation is  
regarded as "error free", if the  
computed standard deviation of the  
orientation is within twice the entered  
value.  
Ht Acc TP  
: Height accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The height is regarded as "error free",  
if the computed standard deviation is  
within twice the entered value.  
88  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Posn Acc TP : Position accuracy of the target points.  
The entered value, is used as an "a  
priori" accuracy in the calculation.  
The position is regarded as "error  
free", if the computed standard  
deviation is within twice the entered  
value.  
FS  
Two Faces  
: YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
User Disp  
: YES; the measured value indication is  
used from application "Measure and  
record".  
NO; the default indication is used for  
the "Free Station".  
Log File  
: ON, records measurements in a Log-  
File.The format is described on page  
90.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name  
Display software-version  
Set the values to default. Default values are shown in  
the previous dialog.  
Exit the program.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "STATION DATA".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
Dual-face Measurement  
FS  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
Record  
For each measurement, a record will  
be stored containing :  
- Station coordinates and  
- orientation correction,  
- standard deviations for  
Easting,  
Northing,  
Height of station  
and orientation correction.  
90  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The residuals for  
- horizontal angles,  
- heights and  
- measured distances  
are also listed.  
FS  
Leica VIP Free Station V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
Meas. file  
:
:
:
:
TCM1800, Serial 410000, (not named)  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
Program Start  
02/05/1996 at 11:23  
Using Least-Squares Solution  
Station no.  
:
200  
E= -3.5461m N= -0.7683m ELV= -0.6518m hi= 0.0000m  
Ori.Corr.  
:
:
:
:
:
0°00'20"  
0.0003m  
0.0003m  
0.0015m  
0"00'02"  
S.Dev. East  
S.Dev. North  
S.Dev. Elev.  
S.Dev. Orient.  
4 point(s) measured :  
## Point no.  
d Hz  
d Height  
0.0012m  
-0.0045m  
0.0018m  
0.0014m  
d Distance  
-0.0000m  
-0.0002m  
0.0010m  
-0.0002m  
Error Flag  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
1 109  
2 110  
3 112  
4 113  
0°01'21"  
-0°00'00"  
-0°00'25"  
0°00'48"  
Continued next page  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Robust Solution  
Station no.  
:
200  
E= -3.5461m  
0°00'20"  
0.0003m  
0.0003m  
0.0015m  
0°00'02"  
N= -0.7683m ELV= -0.6518m hi= 0.0000m  
Ori.Corr.  
:
:
:
:
:
S.Dev. East  
S.Dev. North  
S.Dev. Elev.  
S.Dev. Orient.  
4 point(s) measured :  
## Point no.  
d Hz  
d Height  
d Distance  
-0.0000m  
-0.0002m  
0.0010m  
-0.0002m  
Error Flag  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
1 109  
2 110  
3 112  
4 113  
0°01'21"  
-0°00'00"  
-0°00'25"  
0°00'48"  
0.0012m  
-0.0045m  
0.0018m  
0.0014m  
FS  
Typical log file entry in the "FREE STATION" program  
92  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference Line  
This manual describes the "REFERENCE LINE"  
program of the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
The distance and the angle between two points is  
calculated by the program.  
Introduction  
"REFERENCE LINE" is a specialized form of stakeout  
used for construction and building alignment. It permits  
positioning of a point referred to a line. Points for use in  
the program can be measured, entered manually, or read  
from the database.  
The program records individual measurements in the  
database. In addition, the program generates a log file  
containing all data for a given measurement session.  
RL  
Line  
Pt2  
Offset  
Pt1  
H
N
Target pt  
Offset  
α
Line  
E
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The program also allows to determine various values of  
height determination as shown in the figure below.  
Target point  
Offset  
H1  
H2  
FP  
P2  
NP  
P1  
Line  
RL  
FP  
NP  
Point of intersection of vertical with  
line P1-P2  
Point of intersection with line P1- P2  
of perpendicular to P1- P2  
H1  
Height difference to start of line P1  
H2  
Height differencein relation to the  
interpolated height FP of reference  
line P1-P2.  
Line  
Horizontal distance from P1 to FP  
(abscissa)  
Spat.dist  
Spatial distance from P1 to NP  
Perp.l  
Length of perpendicular from Target  
point to Reference line  
94  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Baseline Points  
This dialog defines the two points of the baseline. You  
can either manually enter, measure or search for the  
point in the database.  
Determine Base Points  
14:03  
REFLN\ REFERENCE LINE  
1. POINT BASELINE  
Rec. device :  
Search in :  
MEMORY-CARD  
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT MEAS  
HELP CONF  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RL  
Manually enter the first base point. The TPS 1000  
manual input dialog will appear.  
Proceed to determine the base point by a measurement.  
Initiate a search of the point in the database.  
Start the "Configuration Editor".  
or  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure a Base Point  
This dialog is used in accordance with the settings of  
the system function "Measure & Record" or according  
to the dialog shown below.  
14:03  
12  
REFLN\ REFERENCE LINE  
Puoint no. :  
Hz  
V
:
:
286°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
Refl.Height :  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
1.500 m  
22.039 m  
2.543 m  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record in the active file.  
Proceed with the dialog "1 POINT BASELINE" (page  
95). If the second point has already been measured, the  
program will proceed to the "DEFINE REF LINE"  
dialog.  
RL  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement in the active file and proceed  
with the dialog "1 POINT BASELINE" (page 95). If  
the second point has already been measured, the  
program will proceed to the "DEFINE REF LINE"  
dialog.  
Measure the distance. Accept the measurement without  
recording. If the second point has already been  
measured, the program will proceed with the "DEFINE  
REF LINE" dialog.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
96  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Exit the program.  
RL  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Define Reference Line  
The reference line can be defined by entering a distance  
value, a line offset value and an angle value for the base  
line. Heights can be changed by a constant rate (eg, 1m)  
by entering a H offset value.  
14:03  
12  
REFLN\ DEFINE REF LINE  
1.BasePoint :  
2.BasePoint :  
13  
Offset  
Line  
:
:
:
:
1.000 m  
1.558 m  
Alpha  
2°03'39"  
H Offset  
0.500 m  
NEWL  
MEAS  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RL  
1.BasePoint : The first base point that defines the  
base line.  
2.BasePoint : The second base point that defines the  
base line.  
Offset  
Line  
: Establishes the displacement parallel  
to the base line.  
: Establishes the distance from the first  
reference point to the starting point of  
the new reference line.  
Alpha  
: Establishes the angle between the base  
line and the new reference line.  
H Offset  
: Displaces the base line parallel in  
height.  
Define a new base line.  
Accept parameters as displayed and proceed to the  
"RESULT REF LINE" dialog.  
or  
98  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Results Reference Line  
The "RESULTS REF LINE" dialog displays the data of  
the measured point refering to the reference line, as  
shown in dialog below:  
14:03  
12  
REFLN\RESLUTS REF LINE  
Point no. :  
Offset  
Line  
H  
:
:
:
0.020 m  
1.468 m  
-0.558 m  
0.039 m  
3.020 m  
Perp.lngth :  
Spat. dist :  
ALL DIST REC TAGT  
Elevation :  
103.020 m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RL  
Point No.  
: The point number of the stakeout  
point.  
Offset  
: The delta value of line Offset in  
reference to the stakeout point.  
(ordinate)  
Line  
: The delta value of Line in reference  
to the stakeout point. (abscissa)  
H  
: Height difference between the  
stakeout point as measured and the  
height reference point.  
Perp.lngth. : Length of perpendicular  
Spat.dist.  
: Spatial distance  
Elevation  
: Height of target point.  
If "Offset" is brought to "0" by turning the instrument,  
a distance measurement must always be carried out for  
control purpose.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simultaneously execute distance measurement and  
record the measurement.  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement in the database.  
Depending on the setting in the "Configuration" dialog  
a measurement block containing delta values is  
recorded:  
WI 11  
WI 35  
WI 37  
WI 39  
Point Number of target  
Offset  
H  
Line  
or  
WI 11  
WI 35  
WI 37  
WI 39  
Point Number of target  
Offset  
Perpendicular  
Spatial distance  
RL  
Depending on the setting in the "Configuration" dialog  
a record is written in the log file.  
When finished, the program will proceed the "DEFINE  
REF LINE" dialog.  
Enter target data as described in the Measure & Record  
of the System Manual.  
Exit the program.  
Proceed with dialog "DEFINE REF LINE".  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
100  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "1. POINT  
BASELINE" dialog.  
14:03  
ON  
REFLN\ CONFIGURATION  
Offset  
:
:
:
:
:
:
Line / α  
H.Offset.  
Rec Diff  
User Disp  
Height  
OFF  
OFF  
NONE  
NO  
Ref  
INFO  
DFLT OFF  
Log File  
:
OFF  
Log FlName : REFLINE.LOG  
RL  
HELP  
S
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" lets you change and set the  
following parameters that determine program operation:  
Offset  
: Set to ON, the program will allow the  
input of an offset from the reference  
line.  
Line / α  
: Set to ON, the program will allow the  
input of a distance from the first base  
point to the starting point of the new  
reference line, and also an angle  
between the base line and the new  
reference line .  
H Offset  
: Set to ON, the program will allow the  
input of a height offset.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rec Diff  
: Set to NONE, no additional  
measurement is recorded.  
Set to O the program will record ∆  
Offset values only.  
Set to O/ L, the program will record  
both Offset and Line values.  
Set to O/L/H, the program will record  
Offset, D Line and Height of target  
values.  
If the option "Height" is set to  
"Inter" you can in addition calculate  
the values:  
Set to O/S the program will record  
both Offset and Spatial distance  
values.  
Set to O/S/P, the program will record  
Offset, Spatial distance and  
Perp.length of the perpendicular line.  
(Refer to figure page 94)  
RL  
User Disp  
Height  
: Set to YES, the display defined in the  
MEAS application will be used.  
If set to NO, the "REFERENCE  
LINE" default display applies.  
: Set to Ref, Height (1) will be  
calculated from the first base point  
and the reflector.  
Set to Inter, the program will  
calculate Height (2) from the  
interpolated height of the base line at  
Line of the reflector position and  
the reflector position itself.  
If set to Inter, the Line / a option is  
set to NO automatically.  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in a log file in the  
format described on page 103.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
102  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Press to reset configuration parameters to their default  
values. Default settings are shown in the previous  
dialog.  
Store the current configuration and proceed with dialog  
"1. POINT BASELINE".  
Key to choose the different functions.  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
RL  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as dateand time.  
Configuration each modification of baseline and  
reference line is stored.  
Record  
For each measurement, a record will  
be stored containing: Point No., as-  
staked Easting, Northing, and  
Elevation and their delta values.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Reference Line V 2.10  
Instrument  
User Templ.  
Meas. File  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 430000, Joe’s theodolite  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
02/23/1995 at 13:00  
Program Start  
Station no.  
:
Stationpointnumber  
E=1000.000m N=2000.000m H=400.000m hi=1.1150m  
1.BasePoint  
2.BasePoint  
:
:
Baselinepointnumber  
E=1050.000m N=2050.000m H=410.000m  
Baselinepointnumber  
E=1060.000m N=2060.000m H=420.000m  
Offset.  
Line  
Alpha  
H Offset  
Height  
:
:
:
:
:
1.0000m  
2.6700m  
72°45'66"  
1.0000m  
REF  
Point no.  
Deltas  
:
1025  
E=1055.000m N=2055.000m H=415.000m hr=1.1150m  
RL  
:
:
:
dP= 4.3403m  
dL= 3.0907m  
dH= -1.5027m  
Typical log file entry in the "REFERENCE LINE" program  
104  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Height  
This manual describes the "Remote Height" program of  
the TPS System 1000 theodolite series. The distance  
and the angle between two points is calculated by the  
program.  
Introduction  
The elevation of a remote height point is calculated  
from the zenith angle to the target and from the  
measured distance to a reflector situated vertically  
below or above that target.  
To ensure correct results, the target and the reflector  
must be lined up vertically. In practice it is not generally  
possible to maintain an exactly-vertical line, and so you  
must decide what lateral deviation can be tolerated. The  
horizontal distance to the inaccessible target must  
however coincide with the horizontal distance to the  
reflector.  
RH  
When the instrument is aligned and the station  
coordinates have been set, the position coordinates of  
the remote height can be calculated and stored in the  
data file.  
H
N
V  
H  
E0  
N0  
E
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This dialog is used in accordance with the settings of  
the system function "Measure & Record" or according  
to the dialog shown below.  
Measure Base Point  
14:03  
Station12  
16°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
REMHT\ MEASURE BASE PT  
Point no. :  
Hz  
V
:
:
Refl.Height :  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
1.664 m  
----- m  
-----  
ALL DIST REC TARGT REMOT αNUM  
HELP CONF  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point No.  
Hz  
: The point number of the base point.  
: Horizontal direction from the remote  
point to the base point.  
RH  
V
: Vertical angle to the remote point.  
Refl.Height : Reflector height used for the target  
point.  
Slope dist.  
Height diff  
: Slope distance from the instrument  
station to the base point.  
: Height difference between the base  
point ground and the instrument  
ground.  
Simultaneously measure and record in the active file.  
Proceed with the "REMOTE POINT" dialog.  
Measure a distance. Record the measurement in the  
active file and proceed with the "REMOTE POINT"  
dialog.  
Measure the distance. Accept the measurement without  
recording. Proceed with the "REMOTE POINT" dialog.  
106  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the target data. . For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of the "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Proceed with "REMOTE POINT" dialog.  
Start the "Configuration Editor".  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of the "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Exit the program.  
Alpha-numerical/numerical input.  
RH  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Remote Point  
Once the base point has been measured, this dialog  
shows the position of the point - above or below the  
base point - aimed with the telescope. The data are  
immediately updated while turning the instrument.  
14:03  
REMHT\ MEASURRE REMOTE PT  
Point no.  
:
:
:
Station12  
Hz  
V
16°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
Slope Dist. :  
23.345 m  
Hgt diff  
:
:
6.435 m  
Easting  
3453.998 m  
STORE TARGT BASE  
Northing  
:
:
124.003 m  
768.005 m  
Elevation  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RH  
Point No.  
Hz  
: The point number of the remote point.  
: Horizontal direction from the  
instrument to the remote point.  
V
: Vertical angle to the remote point.  
Slope dist.  
: Slope distance from the instrument  
station to the remote point.  
(calculated)  
Hgt diff  
Easting  
: Height difference between the remote  
point and the base point ground.  
: Calculated Easting (Y) for the remote  
point.  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Calculated Northing (X) for the  
remote point.  
: Calculated Elevation for the remote  
point.  
108  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Record the measurement in the database.  
Enter the target data. . For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of the "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Return to the "MEASURE BASE POINT" dialog.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of the "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Return to the "MEASURE BASE POINT" dialog.  
Exit the program.  
RH  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "MEASURE  
REMOTE POINT" dialog.  
14:03  
REMHT\ CONFIGURATION  
User Displ :  
Hor.Pos.Tol :  
Rec H WI37 :  
NO  
0.200 m  
OFF  
INFO  
HELP  
DFLT YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
RH  
User Disp  
: Set to YES, the display defined in the  
"MEAS" application will be used.  
If set to NO, the "REMOTE  
HEIGHT" default display applies.  
Hor.Pos.Tol : Horizontal distance tolerance that  
valid point measurements cannot  
exceed.  
Rec H WI37:Set to ON, the program will store ∆  
height difference as record WI37 in  
the database.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Reset configuration parameters to their default values.  
Default settings are shown in dialog above.  
Accept the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "MEASURE BASE PT".  
110  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hidden Point  
This manual describes the "HIDDEN POINT" program  
of the TPS SYSTEM 1000 instruments.  
Introduction  
The program allows measurements to a point that is not  
directly visible using a special hidden-point rod. The  
data for the hidden point are calculated from  
measurements to the prisms mounted on the pole with a  
known spacing and a known length of pole. The pole  
still may be kept slope.  
"Measurements" are calculated as if the hidden point  
was observed directly. These "calculated  
measurements" can also be recorded.  
The hidden-point rod can have either two or three  
reflectors. The rod you are using is defined in the  
"CONFIGURATION" of the program. Here, you enter  
the length of the rod, spacing between reflectors, and  
the prism constant. Refer to Figure on page 112, which  
illustrates a hidden-point rod with three reflectors.  
HP  
If the hidden-point rod you are using has three  
reflectors, the program calculates coordinates for the  
hidden point from three combinations:  
Reflector 1 + Reflector 2  
Reflector 3 + Reflector 2  
Reflector 1 + Reflector 3  
In the case of motorized theodolites, you can configure  
the program in such a way, that it points the telescope at  
the third reflector automatically after the first two  
reflectors have been measured.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
R1-R3  
R1-R2  
H
N
Total  
length of  
rod  
E0  
N0  
E
Configuration  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "MEASURE"  
dialog.  
HP  
14:03  
NO  
HDNPT\ CONFIGURATION  
User Displ :  
Meas. Tol. :  
0.020 m  
0.000 m  
3
Add. const. :  
No. of Refl :  
Auto Pos.  
:
ON  
Rod Length :  
INFO  
5.000 m  
DFLT YES  
Space R1-R2 :  
Space R1-R3 :  
1.000 m  
0.500 m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration" let you set the following  
parameters that determine program operation and define  
the hidden-point rod you are using:  
User Displ  
: YES use the display defined in  
"MEASURE & RECORD".  
Set NO use the default display of the  
program "HIDDEN POINT".  
112  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Meas. Tol  
: Limit for the difference between the  
given and measured spacing of the  
reflectors. If the tolerance value is  
exceeded, the program will issue a  
warning.  
In case of measurements with 3 prism  
the values are also used as limit for  
the max. deviation of the 3  
measurements.  
Add. const. : Input of prism constant for the prisms  
of the pole. The prism constant set in  
the system is disregarded.  
No. of Refl. : Number of the reflectors on the rod  
you are using. Move the input cursor  
to this line, then toggle to either 2 or 3.  
Auto pos.  
: On  
the program will automatically  
point the telescope of a motorized  
theodolite at the third reflector once  
the first two reflectors have been  
measured. The exact pointing must be  
HP  
made manually.  
Rod Length : Total length of hidden-point rod.  
Space R1-R2 : Spacing between the centers of  
reflector R1 and reflector R2.  
Space R1-R3 : Spacing between the centers of  
reflector R1 and reflector R3. Enter  
only for rods with three reflectors.  
Reflector 3 must be situated between  
reflector 1 and 2.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Set values to default. Default values are displayed on  
page 112.  
Accept the current configuration and proceed to  
"MEASURE ROD"  
Note that all parameters for the rod you are using must  
be defined before you can proceed. If any of the  
parameters have not been defined, the program will  
issue an error message to this effect. Press OK to clear  
the message, then make any necessary settings in the  
"CONFIGURATION".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Rod  
The program will display the TPS 1000 "Measure &  
Record"dialog or the dialog shown below.  
If the difference of the given and measured spacing  
between the reflectors exceeds the "Meas. Tol. limit" a  
message is displayed.  
You may accept the measurement or re-measure the  
reflector.  
14:03  
HDNPT\ MEASURE PRISM 1  
Point no.  
:
:
:
Station12  
Hz  
V
16°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP CONF  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
HP  
Simultaneously measure and record in the active file.  
Proceed with the same dialog for the next reflector. If  
the last point has already been measured, the program  
will proceed to the "RESULT" dialog.  
Measure a distance. Record the measurement in the  
active file and proceed with the same dialog for the next  
reflector. If the last point has already been measured,  
the program will proceed to the "RESULT" dialog.  
Measure the distance. Accept the measurement without  
recording. Proceed with the same dialog for the next  
reflector. If the last point has already been measured,  
the program will proceed to the "RESULT" dialog.  
The prism constant used in the program is shown in the  
distance measurement display during the distance  
measurement. The prism name also shown in this  
display has nothing to do with the prism constant and  
can be ignored.  
114  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Choosing another reflector and therefore another prism  
constant via this function is NOT recommended  
because the actually selected prism constant is only  
used for the current measurement. After confirming/  
storing a measurement with  
/ "REC" or "ALL" the  
prism constant set in the program configuration is  
automatically used again. This could result in errors.  
Therefore always set the prism constant of the pole in  
the configuration of the program. Refer to pages 112  
and 113.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function, input of a code block.  
HP  
Results  
Once all reflectors have been measured, the program  
will display the results of the hidden-point calculation.  
If 3 reflectors are used, the hidden point position  
obtained from the median value of the 3 combinations is  
displayed.  
14:03  
HDNPT\ RESULTS  
Point no.  
:
:
:
Station12  
Hz  
V
16°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
3.345 m  
-0.435 m  
Easting  
NEW  
:
2253.635 m  
REC TARGT  
Northing  
Elevation  
:
:
12145.281 m  
306.005 m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
Hz  
: The Point number.  
: Horizontal direction to the hidden  
point.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
V
: Vertical angle to the hidden point.  
Slope. Dist. : Slope distance to the hidden point.  
Height Diff : Height difference from instrument  
station to the hidden point.  
Easting  
: Calculated Easting (E) for the hidden  
point.  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Calculated Northing (N) for the  
hidden point.  
: Calculated Elevation for the hidden  
point.  
Take a new hidden-point measurement.  
HP  
Store the point calculation on the recording device.  
If the prism constant is also stored (depending on the  
REC mask) during storing of the calculated data of the  
hidden point this value can be ignored because it is not  
relevant for the calculation.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Proceed to measure a new hidden point.  
Exit the program.  
116  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Area (Computation of Area)  
This manual describes the "AREA" program of the TPS  
SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
Pt1  
Pt2  
N
H
Pt3  
Pt6  
PT5  
Pt4  
AR  
E
An area can be defined by a series of straight lines and  
arcs. Arcs are defined by 3 radial points or 2 radial  
points and radius.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
Straight line  
14:03  
AREA\ MEASURE POINT  
Segs Meas. :  
0
1
Point no.  
:
Refl.Height :  
0.000 m  
Hz  
V
:
:
95°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
----- m  
Slope Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT IMPOR  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
:
Northing  
Elevation  
Azimuth  
206.7963 m  
182°25'05"  
0.203 m  
Seg. Len.  
HELP CONF DEL CALC ARC NEW  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
AR  
Segs Meas. : Counts the number of segments. With  
a new area the segment counter will be  
set to zero.  
Seg. Len.  
: Length of the last straight line  
segment measured.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device. Return to dialog "MEASURE  
POINT"  
Measure a distance and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Import target coordinates. For further information,  
please refer to chapter "Setup" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
118  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start the "Configuration editor".  
Deletes last completed segment. Resume at the start of a  
new segment.  
Close the area polygon to the start point and calculates  
area and length of perimeter. The display of the results  
is shown in chapter "CALCULATION".  
Select arc as the next segment.  
Resets the segment counter to zero. Results of the last  
area computation will be erased.  
Call up the CODE function.  
AR  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Arcs  
During measurement, you can choose the ARC function  
to measure an arc defined by 3 radial points or 2 points  
and radius.  
Select the correct options before proceeding with the  
first point of the segment.  
Ensure the central angle of any arc is always smaller  
than 180° (200 gon).  
• Three Points  
Determine the three points of an arc sequentially.  
Completing the third point the program continues with  
Dialog "Measure point" (page 118).  
14:03  
AR  
AREA\ 3 POINT ARC  
3 point ARC, starting point:  
Point no.  
:
1
Refl.Height :  
0.000 m  
Hz  
V
:
:
95°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
----- m  
Slope Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT IMPOR  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Easting  
Northing  
Elevation  
:
:
:
HELP  
RAD  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
120  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Import target coordinates. For further information,  
please refer to chapter "Setup" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Select arc defined by 2 points and radius.  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Exit the program.  
AR  
• Radius Arc  
Determine the two points of an arc sequentially. After  
the second point the "Measure point" dialog (page 118)  
prompts to input the radius.  
14:03  
AREA\ RADIUS ARC  
Radius ARC, starting point:  
Point no.  
:
1
Refl.Height :  
0.000 m  
Hz  
V
:
:
95°55'50"  
91°16'20"  
----- m  
Slope Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT IMPOR  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Easting  
:
:
:
Northing  
Elevation  
HELP  
3 PT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Import target coordinates. For further information,  
please refer to chapter "Setup" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Press 3 Pt. to switch to the 3-Point Arc method .  
Call up the CODE function, as described in chapter  
"Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
AR  
Exit the program.  
For arcs to the left enter the radius negative and for  
arcs to the right enter the radius positive.  
14:03  
12  
AREA\ 2 PUNKTE & RADIUS  
Start Pt.  
End Pt.  
Radius  
:
:
:
70  
----- m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Accept the input. Continue with dialog "MEASURE  
POINT" (page118).  
122  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displays number of segments, computed area and  
length of perimeter.  
Calculation  
14:03  
10  
AREA\ RESULTS  
No. Segs.  
Area  
:
:
:
:
892.888 m²  
0.089  
Hectares  
Perimeter  
295.563 m  
NEW  
STORE  
PLOT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
No. Segs.  
Area  
: Number of segments used.  
: Computed area in units of measure.  
Hectares/  
Acres  
: Computed area in hectares or acres1 .  
1 acre = 43560 ft².  
AR  
Perimeter  
: Length of perimeter of the current unit  
of measure.  
1 depending on the setting of the distance unit metre or  
feet.  
Start a new area. Resets the segment counter to zero.  
Results of the last area computation will be erased.  
The following format will be used to record calculated  
area results:  
WI 41:  
Code block identification  
( default = 36 )  
WI 42:  
WI 43:  
Number of segments used.  
Area in the current measurement units,  
always with one decimal place.  
Length of perimeter in the current units of  
WI 44:  
measure with one decimal place.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Area results recording format  
Code  
( default = 36 )  
no. of segments  
area polygon  
length polygon  
perimeter  
=4  
42...+00000004  
WI 42  
4500.3 m2  
43...+00045003  
WI 43  
392.2 m  
44...+00003922  
WI 44  
41001+00000036  
WI 41  
Generate a plot of the area.  
Continue with dialog "MEASURE POINT".  
Exit the program.  
Perimeter  
AR  
Plot  
Shows a plot of the present area.  
14:03  
AREA\  
PLOT  
RESLT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Return to the dialog "RESULTS".  
Umfang  
124  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "MEASURE  
POINT" dialog.  
14:03  
NO  
AREA\ CONFIGURATION  
Two Faces  
Code  
:
:
:
36  
Log File  
Log FlName :  
OFF  
AREA.LOG  
INFO  
HELP  
DFLT YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
AR  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Two Faces  
Code  
: Set YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
: Enter the block identification code for  
recording the area results ( max. eight  
alpha numeric characters )  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in a log file in the  
format described on page 128.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
Display date and version of the running application  
Set the values to default. Default values are displayed in  
dialog above.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "MEASURE POINT". Points can be added to  
the current area or a new area can be started.  
Exit the program.  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
Dual-face Measurement  
AR  
126  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
Record  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
For each section of the area, start  
point and end point, horizontal  
distance and azimuth are stored.  
AR  
For arcs with 2 points and radius the  
azimuth of arc, radius and length of  
arc are also stored.  
For 3 point arcs the direction of arc,  
radius and length of arc are also  
stored.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Area V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
Meas. file  
Program Start  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 430000, Joe’s theodolite  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
02/23/1995 at 13:00  
Segment Number  
Start Point  
End Point  
H Distance  
Azimuth  
:
:
:
:
:
1
1
2
5.5555m  
140°11'17"  
Segment Number  
Start Point  
End Point  
Curve Right  
Radius  
:
:
:
2
2
4
:
:
4.9089m  
2.326m  
ARC Length  
Segment Number  
Start Point  
Second Point  
End Point  
Curve Right  
Radius  
ARC Length  
:
:
:
:
3
4
5
6
AR  
:
:
5.362m  
2.254m  
Number of Segments : 3  
Area  
Hectares  
Perimeter  
:
:
:
9.8496m2  
0.0010  
13.8396m  
Typical log file entry in the "AREA" program  
128  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sets of Angles  
This manual describes the "Sets of Angles" program of  
the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
Set2 (0°00'00")  
Set1(0°00'00")  
N
H
Pt1  
Pt3  
Pt2  
SA  
E
The program permits direction measurements to targets  
of which coordinates are not necessarily known. The  
average direction of all sets, the standard deviation for  
one observed direction and the standard deviation for  
the average of all directions is computed for each target.  
To calculate a result, a minimum of two full sets must  
be observed. Measurements in two faces must exist for  
each target .  
Once the program has "learned" the targets and their  
respective sequence during the first set in face I, the  
observer is guided throughout the following measuring  
sequence.  
A maximum of 250 measurements per instrument  
station (in 2 faces) can be handled in one calculation.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sets Menu  
The point numbers and sequence of the targets are  
stored in the program during the observation of the first  
half set in face I. This is designated as the "Learning  
Phase". The observer is thereafter guided throughout  
the observation sequence, i.e. the targets are proposed  
as per "learned" sequence using the selected  
observation method. To locate the targets easily, the  
horizontal and vertical differences in direction are  
displayed. Turning these differences to "zero", the  
relevant target is visible. Motorized theodolites will  
automatically drive the telescope to the specified target  
point, if the first half set was measured successfully.  
Complete directions must be observed for all targets  
within the first set. A complete direction is defined as a  
direction observed in both faces.  
Sets menu - view  
SA  
During observation the program tests, if the correct face  
is used. As soon as the last "learned" target has been  
observed, the program changes automatically to face II.  
14:03  
SETS\  
SETS MENU  
Measure First Set  
0
Measure Further Set  
1
Calculate Horizontal Sets 2  
Calculate Vertical Sets  
End Program  
3
4
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Start the "CONFIGURATION".  
130  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure Mode  
• Measure First Set  
This option starts the first set and the "Learning Phase"  
of a new instrument station. The point number for the  
targets must be entered in Dialog "FIRST SET".  
14:03  
SETS\ FIRST SET  
Set no.  
Seg. no.  
Face  
:
:
:
1
1
I
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
Auto Meas. :  
501  
1.300 m  
YES  
LIST <-- --> DONE αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Set no.  
: Displays the active set.  
SA  
Seq. no.  
: Displays the sequence number of the  
selected target out of the total number  
of target used.  
Face  
: Displays the face.  
Point no.  
: Target point number.  
Refl.Height : Reflector height of target point.  
Auto Meas. : Automatic measurement ON/OFF  
Entry of target points into a list as well as selecting  
points for multiple use.  
Displays the previous point from the list of points you  
entered. Note that this key will not be available until  
there is at least one point in the list.  
Displays the next point in the list of points you entered.  
Note that this key will not be available until there is  
at least one point in the list.  
Ends the 1. half set and returns to the dialog "SETS  
MENU".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select alpha-numeric/numeric input.  
Exit the program.  
Proceed to the "MEASURE" dialog (displayed below).  
This "MEASURE" dialog is shown during the  
measurement to targets. The program return to the  
dialog "FIRST SET" (page 131) on completion of a  
measurement or to the "FURTHER SET" dialog (page  
133).  
14:03  
501  
1.300 m  
SETS\ FIRST SET  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
Hz  
V
:
:
:
:
249°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
-----  
HZ  
V  
-----  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
EDIT  
HELP  
I<>II  
SA  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Hz / V : Are not activ during the first set. The  
differences are shown for all further sets  
relative to the measurements of the first  
half set.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device. Return to the dialog "FIRST SET".  
Measure and record a distance.1  
Measure without recording the measurement on the  
active recording device.  
Enter the target data. For further information refer to  
chapter "Measure & Record" of the "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Proceed to "FIRST SET".  
1 Distance measurement is optional.  
132  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Measure Further Set  
To measure the sets, the user is guided the measurement  
sequences. The following dialog selects points used  
within the 1. half set. The measurement sequence  
requires no special target selection due to the pre-  
defined configuration.  
14:03  
SETS\ MEASURE SET  
Set no.  
Seg. no.  
Face  
:
:
:
1
1
I
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
Auto Meas. :  
501  
1.300 m  
YES  
<-- --> POSIT  
HELP  
DONE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
SA  
Set no.  
: Displays the active set.  
Seg. no  
: Internal ordinal number from 1st half  
set.  
Face  
: Displays the face.  
Selects the previous point from a list of points.  
Selects the next point from a list of points.  
Turn the telescope to the selected point.  
Returns to the "Sets Menu"  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To detect the targets easily, the horizontal and vertical  
angle differences are shown in a special display. If these  
are "turned to zero", the selected target is visible within  
the field of view.  
Motorized instruments sight the target automatically  
after the successful measurements of the first half set.  
14:03  
TELESCOPE POSITIONING  
Hz- and V-positioning:  
Set direction(s) to zero.  
HZ  
:
:
-3°56'23"  
1°22'25"  
V  
ABORT  
HELP  
OK  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
SA  
Hz :  
Difference in horizontal direction.  
Difference in vertical direction  
V  
:
Ends the telescope positioning.  
Ends the telescope positioning. Are activated if the  
present telescope position is within 27' (0.5 gon) of the  
expected position. This is confirmed accustically.  
or  
Further measurements follow the same rules as  
described in chapter "Measure first set".  
134  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Calculate Horizontal and Vertical Sets  
Calculate Mode  
The display-format is the same for horizontal and  
vertical directions. The data displayed, refer to the  
selected calculation.  
Standard deviations of a single direction in both faces  
(mR) and the standard deviation for an averaged  
direction from all sets (mM) are calculated.  
Computations of standard deviations require, that all  
targets and sets are observed in two faces. Exceptions  
may exist, in which case the standard deviation should  
be seen as an approximation to be used as a field  
control. The correct standard deviations a posteriori can  
be calculated using the recorded data and a suitable  
computation method.  
SA  
14:03  
SETS\ HZ SET RESULTS  
Pts. Active :  
4
2
Set Active :  
mR  
mM  
:
:
0°00'24"  
0°00'17"  
STORE  
MORE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Pts. Active  
: Number of observed points used in the  
calculation.  
Sets Active : Number of observed sets used in the  
calculation.  
mR  
: Standard deviation of one observed  
horizontal or vertical direction.  
mM  
: Standard deviation of an average  
direction from all sets.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Results of sets of angles are recorded in the activ file  
for measurements. (For details see dialog "FORMATS  
AND MORE INFORMATION" )  
Show the results of individual measurements on the  
screen. ( For details see dialog "MORE INFORMATI-  
ON")  
Exit the program  
• Formats and Data Recording  
The following format is used to record results in the  
activ file for measurements.  
Number of measurements and accuracies.  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43  
WI 44  
Code "HZ-RESLT" or "V0-RESLT"  
Number of targets.  
Number of observed sets.  
Standard deviation of a horizontal or  
vertical direction.  
Standard deviation of a horizontal or a  
vertical direction averaged from all sets.  
SA  
WI 45  
HZ-RESLT: (Number of observations and accuracies)  
Code  
Number of  
targets  
Number of  
sets  
mR  
mM  
=4  
=3  
= 52"  
= 37"  
410039+HZ-RESLT 42....+00000004 43....+00000003 44....+00000520 45....+00000370  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43  
WI 44  
WI 45  
136  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directions averaged from all valid sets.  
WI 41: Code "HZ-MEAN0" or "V0-MEAN0".  
WI 42: Point number  
WI 43: Averaged direction from all sets.  
HZ-MEAN0: ( Average from all valid sets )  
Code  
Target number  
Average of all sets  
410040+HZ-MEAN0  
410041+HZ-MEAN0  
410042+HZ-MEAN0  
410043+HZ-MEAN0  
42....+00000001  
42....+00000002  
42....+00000003  
42....+00000004  
43....+00000000  
43....+00641040  
43....+01354568  
43....+01944557  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43  
Differences or residuals for the points observed.  
WI 41:  
WI 42:  
Code "HZ-DIFF0" oder  
"V0-DIFF0".  
Point number.  
SA  
WI 43 - WI 48: Difference or residual  
HZ-DIFF0: ( Difference (r) for Hz-directions and  
residuals (v) for vertical directions ).  
Code  
Target numbers  
Differences or residuals  
410044+HZ-DIFF0  
410045+HZ-DIFF0  
410046+HZ-DIFF0  
410047+HZ-DIFF0  
42....+00000001  
42....+00000002  
42....+00000003  
42....+00000004  
43....+10000000......  
43....+10000216......  
43....-10000168......  
43....-10000041......  
.....48....+60000000  
.....48....-60000216  
.....48....+60000168  
.....48....+60000141  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43........ until ........WI 48  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• More Information  
Further information is given relating to the differences  
of the measurements. Single points or full sets can be  
deactivated prior to the calculation.  
14:03  
3
SETS\ MORE INFO - HZ  
Active Pts : 2 Sets:  
Point no. :  
501  
Pnt Status :  
ON  
1
ON  
set no.  
:
Set Status :  
Residual  
:
0°00'00"  
RECLC S<-- -->S P<-- -->P OFF  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
SA  
Active Pts  
Sets  
: Number of points used in the  
calculation.  
: Number of sets used in the  
calculation.  
Point no.  
: Target point.  
Pnt. Status  
: Point used for computation (ON/  
OFF).  
Set no.  
: Present displayed set.  
Set Status  
: Point used for computation (ON/  
OFF).  
Residual  
: Difference in horizontal direction,  
using the direction of the active set  
and the averaged direction of all sets.  
For the vertical directions, the residual  
is used to compute the standard  
deviations.  
138  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Re-calculate the results and return to the dialog showing  
the results.  
Display previous set.  
Display the next set.  
Display the previous point.  
Display the next point.  
Exit the program.  
SA  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A typical example of a Hz - measurement is shown in  
the following list:  
The example shows a survey with 3 sets and 4 targets  
with directions in ° ' ".  
Examples and used  
formulae  
The calculations are carried out according to the  
following table.  
PtNr  
Face I  
Face II Average  
Reduced  
Average  
r= d - b v= r+q v²  
face I+II  
(a)  
average of (d)  
set (b)  
1
2
3
4
0°00'20" 180°00'17"  
0°00'19"  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
0
-4  
-1  
0
+1  
-3  
1
9
0
1
24°43'34" 204°43'31" 24°43'33" 24°43'14" 24°43'10"  
84°47'15" 264°47'11" 84°47'13" 84°46'54" 84°46'53"  
306°41'52" 126°41'42" 306°41'47" 306°41'28" 306°41'28"  
0
+1  
q= -( r)/N -(5")/4  
v=-1  
Σ
Σ
q =  
+1  
1
2
3
4
45°00'13" 225°00'16" 45°00'15"  
0°00'00"  
0
0
+1  
+1  
-2  
0
1
1
4
SA  
69°43'24" 249°43'23" 69°43'24" 24°43'09"  
129°47'06" 249°47'08" 129°47'07" 84°46'52"  
351°41'45" 171°41'44" 351°41'45" 306°41'30"  
+1  
+1  
-2  
q= -( r)/N  
-(0)/4  
0
v=0  
Σ
Σ
q =  
1
2
3
4
90°00'19" 270°00'19" 90°00'19"  
0°00'00"  
0
+2  
-1  
-1  
+1  
-2  
0
1
1
4
0
114°43'28" 294°43'26" 114°43'27" 24°43'08"  
174°47'10" 354°47'15" 174°47'13" 84°46'54"  
36°41'47" 216°41'45" 36°41'46" 306°41'27"  
+1  
q= -( r)/N -(2)/4 -1  
v=-2  
Σ
Σ
q =  
v² = 23  
Σ
Σv²  
23"  
= ±2"  
mR=  
=
(N-1)(s-1)  
(4-1)(3-1)  
mR  
2"  
3  
mM =  
=
= ±1"  
s
140  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A typical example of a V - measurement is shown in  
the following list:  
The example shows a survey with 3 sets and 4 targets  
and directions in ° ' ".  
The calculations are carried out according to the  
following table.  
PtNr  
Face I  
Face II  
Average face Average (d) v = d - a  
I+II (a)  
v²  
1
2
3
4
87°13'58"  
88°42'12"  
89°44'22"  
91°06'47"  
272°46'24"  
271°18'18"  
270°16'00"  
268°53'38"  
87°13'47"  
88°41'57"  
89°44'11"  
91°06'34"  
87°13'46"  
88°41'55"  
89°44'11"  
91°06'33"  
-1  
-2  
0
1
4
0
1
-1  
1
2
3
4
87°14'01"  
88°42'09"  
89°44'27"  
91°06'47"  
272°46'22"  
271°18'20"  
270°16'00"  
268°53'40"  
87°14'49"  
88°41'54"  
89°44'13"  
91°06'33"  
-3  
+1  
-2  
0
9
1
4
0
SA  
1
2
3
4
87°14'01"  
88°42'09"  
89°44'23"  
91°06'49"  
272°46'34"  
271°18'20"  
270°16'04"  
268°53'42"  
87°13'43"  
88°41'54"  
89°44'09"  
91°06'33"  
+3  
+1  
+2  
0
9
1
4
0
Σ V= -2  
34  
Σ v² =  
Σv²  
34"  
4*3-1  
mR=  
=
= ±2"  
N*s-1  
mR  
2"  
3  
mM =  
=
= ±1"  
s
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used formulae and designations  
a = In both faces observed and averaged direction.  
b = In both faces averaged and reduced direction of a  
set  
d = Final averaged direction from all sets.  
r = Difference between a final direction averaged  
from all sets and a single direction of a set.  
q = Average of the differences (r).  
v = Residuals.  
s = Number of sets  
N= Number of targets.  
r = d - b  
v = r + q  
v = d - a  
for horizontal directions  
for vertical directions  
Average of the differences for horizontal directions.  
SA  
Σr  
q = -  
N
Standard deviation of one horizontal direction observed  
in two faces.  
Σv²  
mR=  
(N-1)(s-1)  
Standard deviation of one vertical direction observed in  
two faces.  
Σv²  
mR=  
N*s-1  
Standard deviation of an averaged direction from all  
sets.  
mR  
mM =  
s
142  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "SETS  
MENU" dialog.  
14:03  
<>  
SETS\ CONFIGURATION  
Meas Method:  
User Displ :  
NO  
Hz Tol.  
:
0°00'16"  
V Angle Tol:  
0°00'16"  
OFF  
Log File  
:
Log FlName :  
INFO  
SETS.LOG  
DFLT LIST  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
SA  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Meas Method : > <All targets have to be observed for  
face II in opposite order to the  
observations in face I.  
> >All targets have to be observed in  
face II using the same sequence as for  
the observations in face I.  
Each target has to be observed in  
face II immediately after its  
measurement for face I has been  
completed.  
User Displ  
: Set to YES, the display defined in the  
"MEAS" application will be used.  
NO uses the "SETS OF ANGLES"  
default display.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hz Tol.  
: Input the tolerance for Hz-directions.  
This defines the limit for the  
difference between the actual direction  
and the direction observed within the  
first half set. A change in the horizon-  
tal circle orientation is always  
accounted for, after observing the first  
target within a new set. If the  
tolerance is exceeded, a warning is  
given.  
V Angle Tol : Input the tolerance for vertical  
directions. This defines the limit for  
the difference in the vertical directions  
between the actual observations and  
the directions observed within the first  
half set. If the tolerance is exceeded, a  
warning is given.  
Log File  
: ON, records measurements in a Log-  
File.The format is described on page  
146.  
SA  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
Displays date and version.  
Set default values. Default values are displayed in  
dialog "CONFIGURATION" (page 143).  
Exit the program  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "SETS MENU".  
144  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the  
program used, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file as  
well as date and time.  
Record  
The average horizontal and vertical  
angles of all sets, the standard  
deviation for one measurement and  
the standard deviation of an angle  
averaged from all sets, are stored in  
the Log-File.  
SA  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Sets of Angles V 2.10  
Instrument  
User Templ.  
Meas. File  
: TCM1100, Serial 430000, Joe’s theodolite  
: User 1  
: FILE01.GSI  
: 01/05/1996 at 13:00  
Program Start  
Station no.  
:
132  
E=725362.235m N=263587.236m ELV= 569.587m hi= 1.2000m  
Horizontal set results:  
5 Sets measured with 3 points each.  
Standard deviation of any measurement: 0°00'02"  
Standard deviation of mean from all measurements: 0°00'01"  
1. Point no.: 1  
2. Point no.: 2  
3. Point no.: 3  
mean direction:  
mean direction: 83°25'53"  
mean direction: 179°56'28"  
0°00'00"  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Results of single sets:  
1. Point no.: 1  
Set 1 :  
Residual : 0°00'00"  
Residual : 0°00'00"  
Residual : 0°00'00"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
2. Point no.: 2  
Set 1 :  
SA  
Residual : 0°00'33"  
Residual : -0°00'01"  
Residual : -0°00'32"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
83°25'50"  
83°25'44"  
83°25'15"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
3. Point no.: 3  
Set 1 :  
Residual : -0°00'50"  
Residual : 0°00'57"  
Residual : -0°00'47"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
179°56'28"  
179°56'30"  
179°56'55"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
Vertical set results:  
5 Sets measured with 3 points each.  
Standard deviation of any measurement: 0°00'05"  
Standard deviation of mean from all measurements: 0°00'03"  
1. Point no.:1  
2. Point no.:2  
3. Point no.:3  
mean direction:100°53'56"  
mean direction:94°15'47"  
mean direction:85°57'56"  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Refl.Height: 0.0000m  
Results of single sets:  
1. Point no.: 1  
Set 1 :  
Residual : -0°00'45"  
Residual : 0°00'27"  
Residual : -0°00'52"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
100°53'21"  
100°53'49"  
100°53'59"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
2. Point no.: 2  
Set 1 :  
Residual : 0°00'55"  
Residual : 0°00'08"  
Residual : -0°00'53"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
94°15'52"  
94°15'39"  
94°15'10"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
3. Point no.: 3  
Set 1 :  
Residual : 0°00'54"  
Residual : 0°00'38"  
Residual : -0°00'52"  
average :  
average :  
average :  
85°57'12"  
85°57'37"  
85°57'38"  
Set 2 :  
Set 3 :  
Typical Log-File for "SETS OF ANGLES"  
146  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Traverse  
This manual describes the "Traverse" program of the  
TPS-System 1000 instruments.  
Introduction  
Hz1  
N
H
Pt3  
Pt1  
Pt500  
Pt2  
Pt501  
SP1  
Hz2 Hz3  
E
TR  
Using data about direction and distance, the program  
continuously computes the coordinates of the station (in  
the example shown above, the instrument "moves" from  
one station to the next, previously measured point) and  
aligns the horizontal circle.  
For a point the coordinates of which are known, the  
deviation from the coordinates determined by  
measurement can be computed and displayed.  
There is no adjustment of these differences in  
coordinates and direction. Subsequently, however, the  
measurements stored on the PCMCIA can be processed  
with the assistance of an appropriate software program.  
Individual stations can be calculated as "sideshots"  
(SP). The coordinates and directions of these points are  
also determined in the course of this program.  
If the program is terminated (e.g. to record a detail  
point), the values remain stored. The measurement  
procedure can be resumed after calling up the program  
again.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Traverse Menu  
In this display, the individual functions of the program  
can be called. After a function has been performed, the  
user returns to this display.  
Traverse menu  
14:03  
TRAV\ TRAVERSE MENU  
Occupy station  
Traverse point  
Sideshot point  
Close traverse  
New traverse  
0
1
2
3
4
5
End program  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Start the "CONFIGURATION".  
TR  
148  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Any data of a previous traverse in the memory will be  
erased at the start of a new traverse. To avoid  
unintentional erasing, a confirmation must be made.  
The first dialog requests the entry of the station point  
number, height of instrument, station coordinates and  
the setting of a spezified Hz-angle.  
New traverse  
14:03  
TRAV\ NEW TRAV STATION  
Station no. :  
Inst.Height :  
Stat.Eastng :  
Stat.Northg :  
Stat.Elev. :  
Station100  
1.635 m  
23541.025 m  
55231.177 m  
521.358 m  
Hz  
:
233°15'25"  
REC Hz0 IMPOR αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
TR  
Records manually entered station data on the active  
recording device. The program proceeds to the  
"MEASURE MODE" dialog.  
Set horizontal-circle direction. For further information,  
please refer to chapter "Measure & Record" of "SY-  
STEM" - user manual.  
Import station coordinates. For further information,  
please refer to chapter "Setup" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
Alpha-numeric or numeric input.  
Exit the program.  
Proceed to the "DEFINE BACKSIGHT POINT  
MODE" dialog.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Select method of orientation  
Three different methods of the orientations are available  
1. Confirm the orientation already set in the system.1  
No measurements are performed (SYS).  
2. Calculation of an azimuth from coordinates to one tie  
point. A following measurement to a tie point  
orientates the Hz-circle (INPUT). See page 151.  
3. Manual input of the azimut to one tie point. A  
measurement to the tie point is required (AZI). See  
page 152.  
1
If the orientation was determined with the  
"ORIENTATION" program, for example.  
14:03  
TRAV\DEFINE BACKSIGHT PT  
Rec. device : Memory card  
Search in :  
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
2
INPUT AZI SYS  
HELP  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
TR  
Manual entry of coordinates for tie points. The standard  
input dialog of TPS 1000 is used. Continue with the  
"MEAS" dialog.  
Select the "MEAS" dialog and enter the azimuth.  
Confirms the present orientation. Continues with the  
dialog "TRAVERSE MENU".  
or  
Search coordinates in the active file.  
Exit the program.  
150  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Calculate Azimuth  
This dialog corresponds to the TPS-System 1000 basic  
dialog. On completion of a measurement, the program  
continues either with "MULTIPLE MEAS" or with the  
"TRAVERSE MENU" according to the settings in the  
configuration.  
14:03  
500  
TRAV\ NEW TRAVERSE  
Measure Backsight Point  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
1.300 m  
249°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
----- m  
Hz  
V
:
:
Sloe Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
Height diff :  
----- m  
Easting  
:
:
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Northing  
elevation :  
HELP  
I<>II  
TR  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance1 and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Proceed to the dialog "TRAVERSE MENU".  
Call up the CODE function.  
1
Distance measurement is optional.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Enter Backsight Azimuth  
This dialog corresponds to the TPS-System 1000 basic  
dialog with the additional entry of the backsight  
azimuth.  
On completion of the first measurement, the program  
continues either with "MULTIPLE MEAS" or with the  
"TRAVERSE MENU" according to the settings in the  
configuration.  
14:03  
TRAV\ NEW TRAVERSE  
Measure Backsight Ponit  
BS Azimuth :  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
-----  
500  
1.300 m  
249°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
Hz  
V
:
:
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
BS Azimuth : Enter the backsight azimuth for the  
orientation.  
TR  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance1 and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Call up the CODE function.  
1
Distance measurement is optional.  
152  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupy station  
The instrument is set up for a new traverse point or  
sideshot. The angle measurement (distance  
measurement is optional) is made to a tie point or to the  
last traverse point. This dialog corresponds to the TPS-  
System 1000 basic dialog. After the function has been  
performed, the station coordinates and orientation are  
set in the instrument.  
14:03  
TRAV\ OCCUPY TRAVERSE PT  
Station no. :  
2
Backsight :  
1
Inst.Height :  
Refl.Height :  
1.300  
1.300 m  
Hz  
V
:
:
249°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
ALL DIST REC TARGT SS  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
TR  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Station no.  
Backsight  
: Station point number.  
: Backsight to tie point.  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance1 and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
1
Distance measurement is optional.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selects the last measured sideshot or the last traverse  
point as the new station.2  
Change the theodolite face.  
Proceed to the dialog "TRAVERSE MENU".  
Call up the CODE function.  
2
Only active if a sideshot point was measured.  
TR  
154  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A distance measurement is carried out to the respective  
tie point. Both functions use the same dialog. This  
corresponds to the TPS-System 1000 "MEASURE"  
dialog. On completion of the measurement, the program  
continues either with "MULTIPLE MEAS" or with the  
"TRAVERSE MENU" according to the settings in the  
configuration.  
Traverse Point /  
Sideshot Point  
14:03  
20  
TRAV\MEAS TRAVERSE PT  
Point no. :  
Refl.Height :  
1.300 m  
Hz  
V
:
:
249°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
----- m  
----- m  
Slope Dist. :  
Height diff :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
Easting  
:
:
----- m  
----- m  
----- m  
Northing  
Elevation :  
HELP  
I<>II  
TR  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance without recording.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Close traverse  
The program requires a closing point for comparison  
with the last traverse point measured. The default point  
number is the starting point of the travers.  
14:03  
TRAV\ DEFINE CLOSING PT  
Rec. device : Memory-Card  
Search in :  
FILE02.GSI  
Point/Code :  
123  
INPUT  
HELP  
ST PT  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Enter coordinates using the standard input dialog.  
Confirms the coordinates of the starting point.  
Search coordinates in the database.  
Exit the program.  
or  
TR  
14:03  
3
TRAV\ CLOSURE RESULTS  
No. of Pts. :  
Length  
:
1676.367 m  
0.040 m  
Crd. miscl. :  
Hgt. miscl. :  
0.262 m  
-0.016 m  
-0.037 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
STORE PLOT MENU  
AziCrdMiscl :  
H Precision :  
V Precision :  
90°19'52"  
83569 m  
6528 m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
156  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
No. of Pts.  
Length  
: Number of traverse points  
: Length of traverse  
Crd. miscl.  
Hgt.miscl.  
Easting  
: Coordinate misclosure  
: Height misclosure  
: Misclosure in easting  
Northing : Misclosure in northing  
AziCrdMisc1 : Azimuth of coordinate misclosure  
H Precision : Position precision =  
traverse length  
=
Crd. misclosure  
V Precision : Vertical precision =  
TR  
height difference  
=
Hgt. misclosure  
The results of the traverse are recorded in the file for  
measurements on the active recording device.  
Plot of the traverse.  
Continue with the "TRAVERSE MENU".  
Exit the program.  
Continue with the "TRAVERSE MENU".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Examples  
Codeblock with results of the traverse closure :  
WI 41:  
WI 42:  
WI 43:  
WI 44:  
Code 38  
Number of traverse points.  
Length of traverse (sum of legs).  
Azimuth of misclosure  
410010+00000038 42....+00000005 43....+01013515 44....+01928220  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43:  
WI 44:  
WI 45:  
Code 39  
Misclosure  
Misclosure easting  
Misclosure northing  
Misclosure in height  
410011+00000039 42....+00000123 43....+00000045 44....+00000114 45....+00000087  
WI 41  
WI 42  
Code 40  
Position precision (traverse length /  
misclosure)  
WI 43:  
Vertical precision (height difference /  
misclosure)  
410012+00000040 42....+00008239 43....+00010000  
TR  
Measurementblock with the traverse Station  
Coordinates of station points  
WI 11:  
WI 25:  
WI 84:  
WI 85:  
WI 86:  
WI 88:  
Point number  
Hz (correction of orientation)  
E0 easting coordinate  
N0 northing coordinate  
Height  
Instrument height  
110015+00123456 25.143+14611200 84..40+00001215 85..40-00003153  
86..40+00403285 88..10+00001555  
158  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Generates a plot showing the measurement  
configuration.  
Plot  
14:03  
N
TRAV\  
PLOT  
RESLT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Return to the dialog "CLOSURE RESULTS".  
TR  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "TRAVERSE  
MENU" dialog.  
14:03  
NO  
TRAV\ CONFIGURATION  
Two Faces  
Mult Meas  
Code  
:
:
:
:
NO  
38  
OFF  
Log File  
Log FlName : TRAVERSE.LOG  
INFO  
HELP  
DFLT YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Two Faces  
Mult Meas  
: Set YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
: Set YES for the multiple  
measurement,  
TR  
NO for the single measurement.  
Code  
: Input of code number for recording  
results (maximum 8 characters)  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in the Log File  
according to the format described on  
page 163.  
Log FlName : Enter the Log File Name.  
Displays date and version.  
160  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Set all values to default. Default values are shown in  
dialog on page 160.  
Select (NO/YES, alpha-numeric/numeric input, ON/  
OFF).  
Confirm displayed parameter and continues with the  
"TRAVERSE MENU".  
Dual-face Measurement  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
TR  
Multiple Measurement  
The measurement to a point can be repeated as often as  
desired to achieve a higher accuracy or reliability. The  
mean value of the measurements and the respective  
standard deviation is displayed.  
14:03  
500  
TRAV\ MULTIPLE MEAS  
Point no.  
:
No. of Meas :  
1
0°00'30"  
0°00'22"  
σHZ  
:
:
σV  
σSlope Dist :  
0.001 m  
45°00'52"  
ØHz  
:
MEAS CLEAR REC TARGT ACCEP  
ØV  
: 103°45'25"  
50.125 m  
ØSlope Dist :  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Point no.  
:
The target point number.  
No. of Meas : Counter of the measurements.  
σHz  
:
:
Standard deviation of the horizontal  
direction for a single measurement.  
σV  
Standard deviation of the vertical  
angle for a single measurement.  
σSlope Dist : Standard deviation of the slope  
distance for a single measurement.  
ØHz  
ØV  
:
:
Mean value of the HZ-measurements.  
Mean value of the HZ-measurements.  
ØSlope Dist : Mean value of the slope distances.  
Further measurements.  
Delete all measurements of the current point and start  
again.  
Record the mean value of the measurements on the  
active recording device. Return to the "TRAVERSE  
MENU" dialog.  
TR  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Accept the mean values and return to the "TRAVERSE  
MENU".  
162  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Log File  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
The header line will contain the name 
of this program, information about the  
instrument, the name of the data file  
and date and time.  
Record  
Computed coordinates of traverse  
points are continously stored. The  
option Close traverse in the  
"TRAVERSE MENU" (Dialog page  
148) displays and stores at any time  
the coordinate - differences of traverse  
points of which the coordinates are  
known.  
TR  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP Traverse V 2.10  
Instrument  
User Templ  
Meas. File  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 430000, Joe’s theodolite  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
02/23/1995 at 10:25  
Program Start  
Backsight  
Station  
:
:
500  
Pt.1  
E= -0.679m  
N= 9.545m  
N=10.528m  
N=16.821m  
H= 400.062m  
H= 400.170m  
H= 401.260m  
H= 399.923m  
H= 400.181m  
hi= 1.530m  
hi= 1.650m  
hi= 1.610m  
Station  
:
:
:
:
Pt.2  
E=-13.462m  
Station  
Pt.3  
E=26.513m  
Last Trav.Pt.  
Closing Pt.  
501  
E= -77.949m N= 25.037m  
501  
E= -78.016m N= 24.996m  
No. of Pts.  
Length  
Hor. miscl.  
Vert. miscl.  
DEasting  
DNorthing  
Azi H.miscl  
H Precision  
V Precision  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
4
82.788m  
0.047m  
0.268m  
-0.017m  
-0.031m  
226°51'25"  
2036  
2356  
TR  
Typical log file entry in the "TRAVERSE"  
164  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local Resection  
This manual describes the "LOCAL RESECTION"  
program of the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
Pt2  
Pt1  
H
N
E0  
ELocal  
N0  
E
NLocal  
Two points are measured from any instrument station.  
The first point measured forms the centre of a local  
coordinate system (N=0; E=0; H=0). The second point  
measured determines the direction of the positive N -  
axis.  
The distance between the two points must be at least 50  
mm  
The program can be used to deduce the three-dimensio- LR  
nal local coordinates for the instrument station and the  
orientation of the horizontal circle from measurements  
to 2 target points. To compute the position coordinates,  
at least 4 elements (2 distances and 2 directions) are  
necessary.  
For simultaneous determination of the local station  
elevation, height of instrumentand height of reflector  
must already have been input.  
The program allows measurement in single or dual-face  
mode.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Data  
Enter station point number and height of the instrument.  
14:03  
Station2  
LRES\ STATION DATA  
Station no. :  
Inst.Height :  
1.555 m  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Proceed to the dialog "MEASURE POINT 1".  
Start the "CONFIGURATION"  
Quit program .  
LR  
166  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Target Points  
This dialog is similar to the TPS System 1000’s basic  
"MEASURE MODE" dialog. Once the measurement to  
the first and to the second point is taken, the program  
will proceed to the dialog "RESULTS".  
14:03  
12  
LRES\ MEASURE POINT 1  
Point no. :  
Remark 1  
:
-----  
Refl.Height :  
1.300 m  
2°10'20"  
90°19'52"  
----- m  
Hz  
V
:
:
Horiz.Dist. :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
Height diff :  
1.002 m  
Easting  
:
:
231.463 m  
56.785 m  
72.235 m  
Northing  
Elevation :  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
LR  
Simultaneously measure and record data on the active  
recording device.  
Measure a distance.  
Record the measurement on the active recording device.  
Enter target data as described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" of "SYSTEM" - user manual.  
Change the theodolite face.  
Accept the measurement.  
Call up the CODE function, input of a code block.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Calculation  
In this dialog the calculated station coordinates are  
shown with orientation.  
14:03  
1
LRES\RESULTS <L.SQRS>  
Station no. :  
Easting  
:
:
:
-3.369 m  
0.569 m  
0.235 m  
Northing  
Elevation  
Orientation : 135°34'56"  
SET  
STORE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Station no  
Easting  
: Station point number  
: Calculated E (local) for the station  
: Calculated N (local) for the station  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Calculated Elevation (local) for the  
station  
Orientation : Angular correction needed to orient  
the instrument  
Set orientation and station coordinates on the  
instrument. Note that this key will end the program.  
LR  
Record the following results on the active recording  
device:  
WI 11  
WI 25  
WI 84  
WI 85  
WI 86  
WI 87  
WI 88  
Station Point Number  
Orientation correction  
Station Easting  
Station Northing  
Station Elevation  
Last reflector height used  
Instrument Height  
Exit the program.  
168  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "STATION  
DATA" dialog.  
14:03  
NO  
LRES\ CONFIGURATION  
Two Faces  
:
INFO  
HELP  
DFLT YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
LR  
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
Two Faces  
: YES for dual-face measurement,  
NO for single-face.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Set the value to the default. (Two Faces = NO, see  
display above)  
Store the current configuration and proceed to the  
dialog "STATION DATA".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dual-face Measurement  
In the dual-face mode, the program will prompt for  
measurements in both faces. When both measurements  
are taken, the program will check the difference  
between the two. If the difference in angle is within 27'  
(0.5 gon) and the difference of two measured distances  
is within 0.5 m (1.64 ft), the observations will be  
averaged. These tolerances are used to avoid errors in  
target identification. If exceeded an error message will  
be displayed.  
LR  
170  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Road line  
The manual describes the program "ROAD LINE" for  
the Leica TPS 1000 series.  
Introduction  
centre-line  
offset (-)  
[km] 0  
50  
100  
150  
200  
300  
points to be  
staked  
centre-line  
offset (+)  
RO  
The program is suitable for setting out points which are  
determined by chainage and centre-line offset along a  
calculated alignment. If V-alignments and cross-  
sections are defined for the alignment, the points can be  
calculated and set out spatially ("ROAD  
STAKEOUT").  
Conversely, if a point in the vicinity of the alignment  
has been determined by measurement, the chainage and  
centre-line offset can be determined ("X-SECTION  
CHECK").  
This version of "ROAD LINE" is only valid for a GSI  
configuration.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The program reads the geometrical elements of an  
alignment from files expressed in GSI format. The data  
for the alignment are grouped in accordance with the  
three components of an alignment. The file names must  
comply with certain rules:  
1. Hz-alignment  
File name: ALN?????.GSI  
2. V-alignment  
File name: PRF?????.GSI  
3. Cross section  
File name: CRS?????.GSI  
You can insert a permitted character for a DOS file  
name in place of a ? .  
1. Permitted elements in the Hz-alignment  
• Straight  
• Curve  
defined by chainage and  
coordinates of tarting point  
defined by chainage and  
coordinates of starting point  
Radius of arc (- = left-hand curve  
+ = right-hand curve)  
• Spiral  
defined by  
chainage and coordinates of  
starting point  
parameter A1 of spiral (negative  
parameter = spiral into left-hand  
curve)  
RO  
• End of project (EOP) chainage and coordinates of  
end-point  
1
A² = L x R where L = length of spiral; R = radius of  
curve  
172  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Permitted elements in V-alignments  
Straight  
Curve  
defined by  
chainage and height of starting  
point  
defined by  
chainage and height of starting  
point  
radius of arc (- = crest + = dip)  
Parabola  
defined by  
chainage and height of starting  
point  
parameters of parabola1 (- = crest  
+ = dip)  
End of project (EOP) chainage and height of end-  
point of gradient  
3. Permitted elements in cross sections  
Chainage  
Offset  
Height difference relative to axis  
RO  
To enter the data, you can use a PC and the program  
ROADDATA.EXE supplied, or you can use the pro-  
gram FILE EDITOR on the TPS 1000.  
1
2p x (H - H0) = (S - S0)² S0, H0  
station and height of vertex  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The "ALIGNMENT CALCULATION" program only  
Program concept  
permits measurements in one face.  
Before the program is started, the following procedures  
are carried out:  
1. Setting user profile and name of the data file.  
2. Determining the instrument station and the  
orientation  
"ROAD STAKEOUT" requires the following input:  
1. Chainage for the point to be set out  
2. Offset and height displacement of the point to be set  
out, or zero point of cross section relative to axis  
(optional)  
3. Selection of a point on the cross section (optional)  
On the basis of this input, the coordinates of the point to  
be set out are determined and are transferred to the  
program "SETTING OUT" for post-processing.  
The "X-SECTION CHECK" requires the following  
input:  
1. Measurement to ground point  
RO  
The parameters calculated and displayed are  
respectively the chainage, the offset, and the height  
difference of the point measured with respect to the  
centre-line.  
174  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alignment  
Selection of files  
The files with the definitions for the Hz-alignment, the  
V-alignment and the cross sections are selected. The  
names of the files must be in accordance with the  
guidelines laid down in section "Introduction".  
The Hz-alignment must always be selected. The choice  
of a V-alignment and of transverse sections is optional.  
If no V-alignment is selected, points can only be set  
out or inspected in two dimensions. Without V-  
alignments, no transverse sections can be selected.  
14:03  
ALNTEMP  
ROADL\ SELECT ALN FILES  
Horiz.Aln. :  
Vert. Aln. :  
Cross Secs :  
Log FlName :  
PRFTEMP  
CRSTEMP  
ROAD.LOG  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Aln  
Vert. Aln  
: Selects definition of Hz-alignment.  
RO  
: Selects definition of gradient (optio-  
nal)  
Cross Secs  
: Selects definition of cross section.  
(optional)  
Log FlName : Name of the log file in use.  
Start the "Configuration".  
Continues with dialog "CHECKING FILES".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The files selected are inspected for formal input errors  
Checking files  
and for geometrical deviations.  
The job identification for the three input files is  
inspected, as are possible errors in the data format e.g.  
missing or incorrect word index (WI). Errors are  
indicated by appropriate messages. The inspection can  
be continued or interrupted. If serious formal errors  
are found, the inspection is aborted.  
Geometrical deviations include the tangent directions  
of adjacent elements and the chord lengths of elements.  
Deviations which exceed the permitted tolerance are  
displayed. The inspection of the files can be continued  
or interrupted.  
14:03  
ROADL\ CHECKING FILES  
ALN: Deflection tolerance  
exceeded at chainage 89°18'00".  
Difference in direction is  
0°00'27". Override?  
NO  
YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
After inspection, the program returns to Dialog 2. The  
input values can be corrected, either on a PC using the  
program "ROADDATA.EXE" or on the TPS1000 using  
the programm "FILE EDITOR".  
RO  
176  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exceeding the permitted tolerance is accepted and the  
inspection is continued. Longitudinal errors are  
distributed proportionally by changing the scale.  
Because of the variable curvature, deviations in the  
tangential direction are not taken into account.  
When the program is called up again, the permitted  
tolerance is inspected only if the data have been  
changed or if the tolerance limits have been changed.  
RO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program flow  
Chainage and centre-line The dialog is used to enter the longitudinal and cross  
offset  
section data for a point to be set out, or to call the  
function "X-SECTION CHECK".  
Hght. Shift :  
ChaingeIncr :  
0.000 m  
100.000 m  
14:03  
ROADL\ CHAINAGE &OFFSET  
Chainage  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
:
0.000 m  
POB  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
HghtOffset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Chainage  
: The present chainage for  
"STAKEOUT".  
After setting-out is completed, the  
chainage is automatically changed to  
the next value divisible by  
ChaingeIncr.  
The chainage of the main points  
(change of elements) is displayed  
independently of ChaingeIncr. Any  
desired chainage can be keyed in.  
For the function "X-SECTION  
CHECK" the values displayed and  
data from the cross section do not  
influence the calculation in the "X-  
SECTION CHECK".  
RO  
178  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Element  
Offset  
: The element type on which the  
chainage displayed is located.  
The elements are output in full. Both  
adjacent elements are displayed in the  
main points.  
: Horizontal displacement (offset) of  
the point to be set out in relation to the  
centre line.  
HghtOffset : Height displacement of the point to be  
set out in relation to the centre line.  
(The amount of the vertical  
displacement is also taken into  
account.)  
Hght. Shift : All heights in the alignment are  
changed by this amount. The value  
can only be changed in the dialog  
"CONFIGURATION".  
ChaingeIncr : The chainage difference when setting  
out. The chainage is automatically  
incremented by this amount.  
Calls the function "X-SECTION CHECK".  
Displays the next chainage up which is divisible by  
ChaingeIncr. If the end of the alignment is overshot, a  
warning is given once. After the end of the alignment,  
the calculation is based on the tangent of the last  
element.  
RO  
Displays the next chainage down which is divisible by  
ChaingeIncr. If there is a shortfall at the beginning of  
the alignment, a warning is given once. Before the  
beginning of the alignment, the calculation is based on  
the tangent of the first element.  
Calls the dialog "CROSS SECTIONS".  
Calls the dialog "POINT COORDINATES" in order to  
display the coordinates of the point to be set out. From  
there, calls the program "STAKEOUT".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Selecting points in the cross section  
Cross sections  
For setting out, points on the defined cross section can  
be selected.  
Hght. Shift :  
0.999999 m  
14:03  
1R*  
ROADL\ CROSS SETIONS  
Chainage  
:
100.000  
+TMPL0001  
Cross Sect. :  
CL Offset :  
CL HGTDiff :  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
3.000 m  
Offset  
:
<-- <-- CENTR --> -->  
HghtOffset :  
HELP  
0.000 m  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1R  
: Numbering the profile points from the  
centre line outwards: 1L, 2L, 3L, etc.  
for points to the left; 1R, 2R, 3R etc.  
for points to the right. The centre of  
the cross-sectional profile is numbered  
0C. Points already set out are marked  
* . The display bar displays in  
graphical form the position of the  
point in the profile.  
Chainage  
: Chainage currently valid.  
RO  
Cross Sect. : Name of the valid cross section. A  
different profile can be searched for.  
CL Offset : Horizontal distance from the centre of  
the profile to the current profile point.  
CL Hgt Diff : Vertical distance from the centre of  
the profile to the current profile point.  
180  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Offset  
: Horizontal displacement (centre-line  
offset) of the centre of the X-section  
by this amount.  
HghtOffset : Height displacement of the centre of  
the X-section  
(The value of the HghtOffset is also  
taken into account.)  
Hght. Shift : All heights in the alignment are  
changed by this amount. The value  
can only be altered in this dialog.  
Displays far-left profile point.  
Displays profile point one place further to the left.  
Displays centre of profile.  
Displays profile point one place further to the right.  
Displays far-right profile point.  
Displays diagram of cross section.  
Calls dialog "POINT COORDS" to display coordinates  
of point to be set out. From there, calls program  
"STAKEOUT".  
RO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Plot  
A simple diagram of the cross section is displayed. The  
vertical scale is exaggerated three times.  
14:03  
ROADL\  
PLOT  
XSEC  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Returns to dialog "CROSS SECTION".  
RO  
182  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout  
The coordinates of a stakeout point are displayed and  
passed to the program "STAKEOUT".  
14:03  
ROADL\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage 34225.000  
:
Refl.Height :  
1.634 m  
1010.567 m  
-34213.077 m  
345.655 m  
Easting  
Northing  
Elevation  
:
:
:
STAKE  
HELP  
END  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The coordinates calculated from the input values of the  
dialog "CHAINAGE & OFFSET" or "CROSS  
SECTION" are displayed.  
Calls program "STAKEOUT". The coordinates  
displayed are transferred.  
or  
[km] 0  
50  
100  
150  
200  
300  
RO  
centre-line  
offset  
Terrain  
(actual)  
(-)  
(+)  
actual  
Line (calculated)  
calculated  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
X-section Check  
The function "X-SECTION CHECK" is called in the  
dialog "CHAINAGE & OFFSET".  
Any desired point in the topography is measured.  
The program calculates  
- the chainage,  
- the offset and  
- the height difference  
of the point in relation to the defined centre line.  
[km] 0  
50  
100  
150  
200  
300  
-2,5  
+2,5  
built  
(actual)  
projected  
(calculated)  
+1,2 -3,8  
RO  
H  
184  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
12  
ROADL\ X-SECTION CHECK  
Point no.  
Remark 1  
:
:
-----  
Refl.-Height:  
1.567 m  
HZ  
V
:
:
135°40'47"  
91°34'50"  
88°55'58"  
Horiz.Dist :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT IMPOR  
HELP  
I<>II  
END  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
This displays the defined standard measuring dialog,  
which may be different from the one depicted above.  
Measures and records in the active file and goes on to  
display the chainage and the offset relative to the  
centre-line definition.  
Measures the distance. Stores the measurement in the  
active file and goes on to display the chainage and the  
offset of the point.  
Measures the distance. Does not store the measurement.  
Goes on to display the chainage and the offset relative  
to the centre-line definition.  
RO  
Enters the target-point data. This function is described  
in chapter "Measure & Record" of "SYSTEM" - user  
manual.  
For manually entering the coordinates of a point, or for  
reading in the active coordinate file. Displays the  
chainage and the offset of the point.  
Calls the code function.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display of results  
Displayed are  
- chainage,  
- offset and  
- height offset  
in relation to the centre line.  
Hght. Shift :  
ChaingeIncr :  
0.000 m  
100.000 m  
14:03  
23.456 m  
:Straight line  
-3.553 m  
0.254 m  
ROADL\ CHAINAGE &OFFSET  
Chainage  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
HghtOffset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
HELP  
STORE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Chainage  
Element  
: The chainage of the point measured is  
displayed.  
: The type of element on which the  
point measured is located.  
The names of the elements are  
displayed without abbreviation. In the  
main points, the two adjacent elements  
are displayed.  
RO  
Offset  
: Horizontal displacement (offset) of  
the point measured in relation to the  
centre line. If several results are  
available (eg, at tight corners) the  
point with the shortest distance to the  
centre line is indicated. By changing  
the calculation limits in the  
configuration, the calculation range  
can be limited and as a result, the  
found stationing can be influenced.  
186  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
HghtOffset : Height displacement of the point  
measured in relation to the centre line.  
(The amount of the vertical  
displacement is also taken into  
account.)  
Hght. Shift : All heights in the alignment are  
changed by this amount. The value  
can only be changed in the dialog  
"CONFIGURATION".  
ChaingeIncr : The chainage difference when setting  
out. The chainage is automatically  
incremented by this amount.  
Re-calls the function "X-SECTION CHECK".  
See section "Chainage and centre-line offset".  
See section "Chainage and centre-line offset".  
The result of the road station and offset is stored.  
See section "Chainage and centre-line offset".  
See section "Chainage and centre-line offset".  
RO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Configuration Editor  
Start the "Configuration Editor" from the "SELECT  
ALN FILES" dialog.  
14:03  
0.000  
0.000  
ROADL\ CONFIGURATION  
BaseChainge :  
End Chainge :  
ChaingeIncr :  
Hght. Shift :  
Deflct.Tol. :  
ChaingeTol. :  
100.000 m  
0.000 m  
0°00'16''  
10 m  
INFO  
DFLT EDIT  
3D Stake  
Log File  
:
:
ON  
OFF  
ROAD.LOG  
Log FlName :  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The parameters defining the further course of the  
program are determined in the "Configuration Editor":  
BaseChainge : Setting the starting point for  
calculation when in the "X-SECTION  
CHECK" function.  
EndChainage : Setting the end point for calculation in  
the "X-SECTION CHECK" function.  
RO  
ChaingeIncr : Difference in chainage when setting  
out. The chainage is automatically  
incremented by this amount.  
Hght. Shift : All heights in the alignment are  
changed by this amount. The value  
can be changed only when you are in  
this dialog.  
188  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deflct.Tol.  
: Permissible deviation of the tangent  
directions for adjacent elements. A  
message appears if this value is  
exceeded. The input is always in  
milligon.  
ChaingeTol. : Permissible deviation of the (chord)  
length of an element and of the  
distance calculated from the end-point  
coordinates, expressed in the length  
units set. A message appears if this  
value is exceeded.  
3D Stake  
: ON for setting out positions and  
heights. The height can be set out only  
if the V-alignment has been defined.  
OFF for setting out only positions.  
Neither a V-alignment nor a typical  
cross-section can be set out.  
Log File  
: Set to ON, the program will record  
measurement data in a log file in the  
format described on page 190.  
Log FlName : Enter the log file name.  
RO  
Displays date and version of the program.  
Sets standard values . The values are displayed in  
dialog on page 188.  
Accepts and stores parameters displayed. Continues to  
display "SELECT ALN FILES".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Log File" is set to ON the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
includes:  
- the program used,  
- information about the instrument,  
- the file to store the measurement  
data,  
- the date and the time.  
Configuration the name of the input files for:  
- the Hz-alignment,  
- the V-alignment and  
- the transverse section.  
Measurement - Instrument station with coordinates  
and instrument height.  
- Stakeout point with chainage,  
- offset1 and height displacement2  
relative to centre line,  
- comparison values from planning,  
and associated differences.  
RO  
For the alignment inspection,  
- the coordinates of the point  
measured are stored along with  
- the associated station,  
- the offset and  
- the height difference.  
190  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
2
This value results from  
- the displacement of the zero point of the profile and  
- the displacement taken from the transverse profile.  
This value results from  
- the displacement of the zero point of the profile and  
- the displacement taken from the transverse profile  
- the height displacement in the configuration.  
Leica VIP Road line V 2.10  
Instrument  
User templ.  
Meas. file  
:
:
:
:
TCM1800, Serial 410000, TCM1800  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
Program Start  
02/07/1996 at 10:43  
Hz-alignment  
V-alignment  
Cross Sect.  
:
:
:
ALNMSPLZ.GSI  
PRFMSPLZ.GSI  
CRSMSPLZ.GSI  
Station no.  
:
TRASSE  
E= -10.0000m N= 25.0000m ELV= 400.0000m hi= 0.0000m  
Point no.  
Chainage  
As Measured  
:
:
:
3386  
49.2812, Offset= -4.9130m,  
HghtOffset= 0.2473m  
E= -11.6393m, N= 27.8821m, ELV= 400.8301m  
Point no.  
Chainage  
Design  
Staked  
:
:
:
:
:
3386  
RO  
49.2812, Offset= -4.9130m,  
HghtOffset= 0.2473m  
E= -11.6391m, N= 27.8823m, ELV= 400.8301m  
E= -11.6394m, N= 27.8830m, ELV= 400.8266m  
dE= 0.0004m, dN= -0.0007m, dELV= 0.0035m  
Deltas  
Example of a log file for the program "ROAD LINE"  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Data format  
This section describes the input-data format for the Hz-  
alignment, the V-alignment and the cross section. To  
enter the data, you can use a PC and the program  
"ROADDATA.EXE" supplied, or you can use the  
program "FILE EDITOR" on the TPS 1000.  
Hz-alignment  
The definition of the road elements is based on the main  
points (= starting and finishing points of the  
geometrical element) and on the element parameters.  
Refer to the example in the next diagram.  
1
R
2
3
4
The alignment starts at main point no. 1 and finishes at  
main point no. 4.  
Here, the geometrical elements are:  
Straight - curve - straight.  
The curve radius is R.  
The starting point of a geometrical element is also the  
finishing point of the preceding adjacent element.  
RO  
192  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Element  
Straight  
Defined by:  
Declaration  
STRAIGHT  
000CURVE  
Starting point [E, N]  
Arc  
Start of curve [E, N],  
radius R.  
Spiral into curve  
starting with  
Start of curve [E, N],  
A-parameter  
00SPIRIN  
R= *)  
Spiral out of curve  
ending at R= *)  
Start of curve [E, N],  
A-parameter  
0SPIROUT  
00000EOP  
End of project  
End point [E, N]  
*) The spiral must begin or end with R = .  
The Hz-alignment file is structured as follows:  
1. Header  
2. Data block: Definition 1st geometrical element  
3. Data block: Definition 2nd geometrical element  
4. Data block: Definition 3rd geometrical element  
.....  
n. Data block: Definition of end of project  
RO  
The header  
41....+00Job-ID 42....+HZALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43  
Job-ID: Job identification consists of 8  
alphanumeric characters.  
Fixed name of the Hz-alignment file. May  
not be changed.  
Fixed name of the main-point method. May  
not be changed.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The data block  
11....+0STATION 71....+GEOM_ELE 72....+RAD/PARA 73....+TEMPLATE  
81..10+00000000 82..10+00000000  
WI 11  
WI 71  
STATION: Chainage at the start of the  
element. 8-digit number.  
GEOM_ELE: Geometrical element  
according to table page 190 (STRAIGHT,  
000CURVE, 00SPIRIN, 0SPIROUT,  
00000EOP).  
WI 72  
RAD/PARA: Arc radius or A-parameter for  
the spirals. 8-digit number.  
If WI 71 = STRAIGHT / 00000EOP, then WI  
72 = 00000NON.  
Sign:  
+, for curves to the right (centre of circle to  
the right of the alignment),  
-, for curves to the left (centre of circle to the  
left of the alignment).  
WI 73  
TEMPLATE: Name/number of the cross-  
sectional profile for the geometrical element  
defined in WI 71. 8 alphanumeric characters.  
The following combinations are reserved and  
are not to be used: 00000NON and  
LASTTMPL.  
WI 81  
WI 82  
E-coordinate of the main point (starting  
point, start of curve, end point according to  
table page 190). 8-digit number.  
RO  
N-coordinate of the main point (starting  
point, start of curve, end point according to  
table page 190). 8-digit number.  
194  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Also:  
• The header is always at the beginning of the file.  
• The Hz-alignment file must always contain at least  
two elements.  
• The units and decimal places used in the WIs 11 and  
72 are in accordance with the definitions in WIs 81  
and 82.  
• The chainage is produced from the sum of the  
element lengths.  
• A cross-sectional profile may be assigned more than  
once.  
• Geometrical elements can be combined freely, for  
example as:  
- Transition curve (straight - spiral - arc)  
- Vertex spiral ( straight - spiral into curve  
- spiral out of curve - straight)  
Unusual applications are also possible:  
- Breakpoint (straight - straight)  
- Right-angle (straight - straight, or straight - 90°  
arc - straight)  
• There is no limitation on the size of the Hz-alignment  
file. As a result, as many data blocks as required can  
be entered if a file is created on the PC using the  
DOS program "ROADDATA.EXE". If a file is  
created/edited using the program "FILE EDITOR"  
on the TPS1000 there is a limitation of 200 data  
blocks.  
RO  
Check your data for errors (typing errors, signs etc.)  
before you load it into the memory card.  
The program supports the user during the setting-out by  
controlling the length of curves. It compares the length  
of the element from the chainage (WI 11) with the  
calculated main-point values, thus enabling input errors  
in the chainage or in the coordinates to be detected.  
However, the signs of arcs and of spirals are not  
checked (see example below).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
4
+R  
-R  
2
1
If the wrong sign (-R) is used, the arc is mirrored  
between the main points 2 and 3.  
Example:  
S-line with a straight connection  
410001+Example1 42....+HZALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
110002+00000000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 73....+Tmpl0125  
81..10+02000000 82..10+06000000  
110003+00198832 71....+00SPIRIN 72....-00122474 73....+Tmpl0123  
81..10+02186841 82..10+06068005  
110004+00348832 71....+000CURVE 72....-00100000 73....+Tmpl0123  
81..10+02307751 82..10+06150344  
110005+00450725 71....+0SPIROUT 72....-00100000 73....+Tmpl0123  
81..10+02304071 82..10+06247816  
110006+00550725 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 73....+Tmpl0125  
81..10+02227794 82..10+06310759  
110007+00714138 71....+00SPIRIN 72....+00054772 73....+Tmpl0124  
81..10+02086275 82..10+06392465  
RO  
110008+00789138 71....+000CURVE 72....+00040000 73....+Tmpl0124  
81..10+02037807 82..10+06445859  
110009+00824376 71....+0SPIROUT 72....+00044721 73....+Tmpl0124  
81..10+02048886 82..10+06478120  
110010+00874376 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 73....+Tmpl0125  
81..10+02094478 82..10+06496445  
110011+01127904 71....+00000EOP 72....+00000NON 73....+Tmpl0125  
81..10+02344154 82..10+06540469  
196  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The project start is at the nadir. After the first straight  
there follows a left curve, then a right curve. There are  
also spirals and a straight between the arcs.  
The cross sections are assigned as follows:  
Straight  
Left curve  
Right curve  
Tmpl0125  
Tmpl0123  
Tmpl0124  
The last character at the end of each data line must be a  
space (ASCII character 32).  
WI 11 and WI 41: The block number is located from  
position 3 to 6.  
• V-alignment  
The V-alignment definition (= V-alignment)  
The V-alignment is defined with the main points (1 - 6).  
The main points form the starting and finishing points  
Parabola  
-p  
Parabola  
RO  
4
5
+p  
1
6
3
2
Straight  
Straight  
Straight  
of the geometrical elements. The starting point of one  
element is also the finishing point of the previous  
element.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Element  
Straight  
Defined by:  
Declaration  
Starting point [chainage, H] STRAIGHT  
Arc  
Start of curve [chainage, H], 000CURVE  
radius R.  
Parabola  
Start of curve [chainage, H], PARABOLA  
parabola parameter p  
End of project Finishing point [chainage, H] 00000EOP  
The V-alignment file is structured as follows:  
1. Header  
2. Data block: Definition 1st geometrical element  
3. Data block: Definition 2nd geometrical element  
4. Data block: Definition 3rd geometrical element  
.....  
n. Data block: Definition of end of project  
The Header  
41....+00Job-ID 42....+0VALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
WI 41  
WI 42  
WI 43  
Job-ID: Job identification consists of 8  
alphanumeric characters.  
Fixed name of the V-alignment file. May not  
be changed.  
RO  
Fixed name of the main-point method. May  
not be changed.  
198  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Data block  
11....+0STATION 71....+GEOM_ELE 72....+RAD/PARA 83..10+00HEIGHT  
WI 11  
WI 71  
WI 72  
STATION: Chainage (from the Hz-  
alignment) at the start of the element. 8-digit  
number.  
GEOM_ELE: Geometrical element  
according to table page 195 (STRAIGHT,  
000CURVE, PARABOLA, 00000EOP).  
RAD/PARA: Arc radius or parabola  
parameter. 8-digit number.  
If WI 71 = STRAIGHT / 00000EOP, then WI  
72 = 00000NON.  
Sign: "+" = dip, "-" = crest  
WI 83  
Also:  
HEIGHT: Height H of the main point  
(starting point, start of curve, end point, in  
accordance with table page 195). 8-digit  
number.  
• The header is always at the beginning of a data file.  
• The V-alignment file must be composed of at least  
two parts (starting- and finishing point).  
• The units and decimal places used in the WIs 11 and  
72 are in accordance with the definition in WI 83.  
RO  
• The chainage is given by the sum of the horizontal  
element lengths.  
• Geometrical elements can be combined freely.  
• There is no limitation on the size of the V-alignment  
file. As a result, as many data blocks as required can  
be entered if a file is created on the PC using the  
DOS program "ROADDATA.EXE". If a file is  
created/edited using the program "FILE EDITOR"  
on the TPS1000 there is a limitation of 200 data  
blocks.  
Check your data for errors (typing errors, signs etc.)  
before you load it into the memory card.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
An example of the wrong sign used with an arc of  
radius R or with the parabola parameter p:  
-R/-p  
2
3
+R/+p  
1
4
If the wrong sign (+R/+p) is used, the summit becomes  
a trough.  
Example:  
Crest and dip  
410001+Example1 42....+0VALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
110002+00000000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 83..10+00400000  
110003+00300000 71....+PARABOLA 72....-01142936 83..10+00422500  
110004+00500000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 83..10+00420000  
110005+00550000 71....+PARABOLA 72....+02091126 83..10+00415000  
110006+00850000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON 83..10+00406522  
110007+01127904 71....+00000EOP 72....+00000NON 83..10+00418605  
RO  
The last character in each data line must always be a  
space (ASCII character 32).  
WI 11 and WI 41: The block number is located from  
position 3 to 6.  
200  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Cross sections  
The points in the cross section are defined in  
accordance with:  
- the centre-line offset sCLO (neg.: pt. left / pos.: pt.  
right) and  
- the height difference sH related to the alignment  
point (neg.: pt. lower / pos.: pt. higher than  
alignment)  
alignment  
left  
2
right  
1
3
sCLO (pos.)  
sH (neg.)  
4
5
Aspect:  
chainage increasing  
Element  
Defined by:  
Declaration  
Height difference Planned height difference  
with respect to alignment  
-
RO  
Centerline offset  
Planned centre-line offset  
-
The template file is structured as follows:  
1. Header  
2. Data block: Cross section 1 / point no. 1  
3. Data block: Cross section 2 / point no. 2  
4. Data block: Cross section 3 / point no. 3  
.....  
n. Data block: Cross section x / point no. y  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Header  
41....+00Job-ID 42....+TEMPLATE  
WI 41  
WI 42  
Job-ID: Job identification consists of 8  
alphanumeric characters.  
Fixed name of the template file. May not be  
changed.  
The data block  
11....+TMPLNAME 35..10+DISTANCE 36..10+000HDIFF  
WI 11  
TMPLNAME: Name/number of the cross  
section, consisting of 8 alphanumeric  
characters. The following designations are  
reserved and may not be used: 00000NON  
and LASTTMPL.  
WI 35  
WI 36  
DISTANCE: Centre-line offset of a  
transverse-profile point. 8-digit number.  
HDIFF: Height difference of a transverse-  
profile point. 8-digit number  
Also:  
• The header must always be at the start of a data file.  
• The file must contain at least one cross section.  
RO  
• Profile points belonging to the same cross section  
must always be together in a single data set. The  
points need not be sorted within the data set.  
• The individual transverse-profile data sets need not  
be sorted within the template file.  
• For a cross section file there is a limitation of 200  
data blocks. The maximum number of points in a  
cross section is 48.  
202  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recommendation:  
If in general you prepare an empty template (only the  
zero point), you can at any time choose this template  
in order to manually enter points or to call up axis  
points. Call this template something like AXIS or  
EMPTY.  
Check your data for errors (typing errors, signs etc.)  
before you load it into the memory card.  
Example: Cross section  
41....+Example1 42....+TEMPLATE  
110002+Tmpl0123 35..10-00013000 36..10-00003000  
110003+Tmpl0123 35..10-00010000 36..10-00005000  
110004+Tmpl0123 35..10-00004000 36..10-00000100  
110005+Tmpl0123 35..10+00004000 36..10+00000100  
110006+Tmpl0123 35..10+00010000 36..10-00006000  
110007+Tmpl0123 35..10+00013000 36..10-00003500  
110008+Tmpl0124 35..10-00012000 36..10-00002000  
110009+Tmpl0124 35..10-00011000 36..10-00004000  
110010+Tmpl0124 35..10-00004000 36..10+00000100  
110011+Tmpl0124 35..10+00004000 36..10-00000100  
110012+Tmpl0124 35..10+00011000 36..10-00005000  
110013+Tmpl0124 35..10+00012000 36..10-00002500  
RO  
The last character at the end of each data line must  
always be a space (ASCII-character 32).  
WI 11 and WI 41: The block number is located from  
position 3 to 6.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Leica "ROADDATA.EXE" for providing  
setting-out data files  
The Road - Data Entry  
program  
Once the alignment has been designed using road-  
design software, the resulting data consist of main  
points, element parameters and cross sections. These  
data must be brought into a structure which can be  
loaded into the memory card. There are two ways to  
product the three setting-out data files (Hz-alignment  
file, V-alignment file and transverse-profile file):  
a) writing an individually-customised program to  
automatically generate and convert the necessary  
data  
b) entering the data by hand into the Leica  
"ROADDATA.EXE" program. The program offers a  
convenient way of entering the values by offering  
suitable menu controls. The program reformats the  
data into the structure required.  
Once the three setting-out data files are ready, all you  
need to do is to transfer the data into the memory card,  
using a suitable transfer program.  
Using the "ROADDATA.EXE" program  
• Copy the program from the diskette to your hard  
disk, using the DOS command  
COPY  
and from there into e.g. disk drive C:\.  
• Start the program with the command  
C:\>roaddata  
RO  
• Follow the menu directives. An integrated Help  
function gives you support, particularly when you are  
using the keyboard commands.  
204  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
COGO  
This manual describes the "COGO" program of the  
TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
The following provides a general overview of the  
individual COGO functions.  
Introduction  
The "Inverse" routine computes the direction and  
distance between two points.  
The "Traverse" routine computes a new coordinate  
point given a direction and distance from a known point  
(Polar plotting).  
The "Intersections" routine computes:  
• Bearing-Bearing intersections,  
• Bearing-Distance intersections or  
• Distance-Distance intersections.  
CO  
The function "Offsets" consists of the following  
subfunctions:  
• "Distance point straight line"  
Calculates the difference in length/abscissa and the  
lateral deviation/ordinate with reference to a basis  
line emanating from a known point.  
• "Orthogonal point calculation"  
A new point can be calculated which emanates from  
a basis line using the difference in length/abscissa  
and the lateral deviation/ordinate.  
The "Point Arc" routine computes a radius point given  
any three points.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The point coordinates can either:  
• be determined by measurement,  
• entered manually using a keyboard or  
• read from the memory card.  
Data, both measured and read from the file, can be  
mixed. This means, however, that station coordinates  
and orientation have to be correctly set.  
Directions and distances can be entered manually,  
called up or freshly determined. The values can then be  
amended by means of multiplication, division, addition  
and subtraction.  
The program "Stakeout" can be called up directly from  
the individual result dialog boxes (if available) in order  
to set out the points immediately.  
The program "Stakeout" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
CO  
206  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Start the "Configurations Editor" from the "COGO  
MENU" dialogue.  
14:03  
COGO\ CONFIGURATION  
Direc. Type:  
Bearing  
Offset  
:
YES  
INFO  
HELP  
F1  
DFLT LIST  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F2  
F3  
s
The "Configuration Editor" sets parameters for further  
program operations:  
CO  
Direc. Type : Bearing  
Azimuth  
Offset  
: YES entering a parallel  
displacement is possible  
NO  
entering a parallel  
displacement is not possible  
Displays date and version.  
Set all values to default. The values are shown in the  
dialogue above.  
Accept displayed values and proceed to the dialogue  
"COGO MENU".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function selection  
(COGO Menu)  
14:03  
COGO\  
COGO MENU  
Inverse  
Traverse  
0
1
2
3
4
5
Intersections  
Offsets  
3 Point Arc  
End COGO  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Call up the "Configuration-Editor".  
CO  
208  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Computes distance and direction between two points.  
Inverse (polar  
calculation)  
H
N
Azimuth  
1
Magnetic bearing  
E
2
CO  
Search  
Given  
: • Direction (magnetic bearing or  
azimuth)  
• Horizontal distance  
: • point 1 (y, x)  
• point 2 (y, x)  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1 (and/or 2)  
can be determined by measurement.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function in the "COGO MENU" dialog.  
14:03  
COGO\ INVERSE FROM  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first (second) point of the  
straight line. The standard TPS 1000 input dialog box  
appears.  
Measuring the first (second) point of the straight line.  
This function is described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System" - user  
manual.  
Search for the coordinates of the first (second) point in  
the coordinate file. This function is described in chapter  
"Setups" (Import function) of the "System" - user  
manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
CO  
210  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the result of the polar  
calculation from both the given points:  
14:03  
COGO\ INVERSE RESULTS  
From  
:
:
:
1010  
To  
1020  
Southwest  
Horiz.Dist. :  
89°37'45"  
31.237 m  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
From  
To  
: Display of point number of the first  
point  
: Display of point number of the second  
point  
CO  
Southwest  
: Display of magnetic bearing.  
If "Azimuth" is selected in the  
configuration during "Direc. Type:",  
then the azimuth will be displayed  
between both the points.  
Horiz.Dist.  
: Display of horizontal distance  
between the points  
Return to "COGO MENU".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Computes a new point given a direction and distance  
from a known point.  
Traverse  
H
N
Azimuth  
1
Magnetic bearing  
E
2
Search  
Given  
: • point 2 to be accetped (Y, X)  
: • point 1 (Y, X),  
• Direction (magnetic bearing or  
azimuth),  
• Horizontal distance.  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1 can be  
determined by measurement.  
CO  
212  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the "COGO MENU".  
14:03  
COGO\ TRAVERSE FROM  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first point. The standard TPS  
1000 input dialog box appears.  
Measuring the first point.  
CO  
This function is described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System" -  
user manual.  
Search for the coordinates of the first point in the  
coordinate file. This function is described in chapter  
"Setups" (Import function) of the "System" - user  
manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Bearing" is selected in the configuration during  
"Direc. Type:", then the following dialog box appears:  
Defining direction by  
magnetic bearing  
14:03  
1
COGO\  
TRAVERSE  
Direction to Traverse  
Quadrant  
NorthEast  
Offset  
:
:
:
0°00'00"  
0.000 m  
RCALL EDIT  
INV  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Quadrant  
: Enter quadrant:  
1 = NorthEast  
2 = SouthEast  
3 = SouthWest  
4 = NorthWest  
Northeast  
Offset  
: Enter magnetic bearing  
: Enter parallel displacement.  
Only active if "YES" is entered in the  
configuration during "Offset:"  
Left = negative parallel offset  
Right = positive parallel offset  
CO  
Determining the direction by means of the function  
"Polar calculation"(refer to chapter "Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Enter quadrant, magnetic bearing.  
Call up of a direction which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
Accept displayed values and proceed with dialogue  
"TRAVERSE" (page 218).  
214  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the direction see under existing dialog box  
"MODIFY BEARING"  
Exit the program.  
14:03  
COGO\ MODIFY BEARING  
NorthEast  
Multiply  
Divide  
:
:
:
:
:
:
0°00'00"  
-----  
-----  
Add  
Subtract  
NorthEast  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
CO  
NorthEast  
: Display of entered magnetic bearings  
(ref. to dialogue "TRAVERSE", page  
214)  
Multiply  
Divide  
Add  
: Entering multiplication factor  
: Entering division factor  
: Entering angle for a correction to the  
right  
Subtract  
: Entering angle for a correction to the  
left  
NorthEast  
: Display of corrected magnetic  
bearings  
Accept displayed values and proceed with dialogue  
"TRAVERSE" (page 218).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Azimuth" is selected in the configuration during  
"Direc. Type:", then the following dialog box appears:  
Defining direction by  
Azimuth  
14:03  
COGO\ TRAVERSE  
Direction to Traverse  
Azimuth  
Offset  
:
:
0°00'00"  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Azimuth  
Offset  
: Entering Azimuth  
: Entering parallel displacement.  
Only active if "YES" is entered in the  
configuration during "Offset:"  
Left = negative parallel offset  
Right = positive parallel offset  
Determining the direction by means of the function  
"Polar calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering Azimuth  
Call up of a direction which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
CO  
Accept displayed values and proceed with dialogue  
"TRAVERSE" (page 218).  
Changing the direction (refer to dialogue "MODIFY  
AZIMUTH ", page 217)  
Exit the program.  
216  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
COGO\ MODIFY AZIMUTH  
Azimuth  
Multiply  
Divide  
Add  
:
:
:
:
:
:
0°00'00"  
-----  
-----  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
0°00'00"  
Subtract  
Azimuth  
EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Azimuth  
: Display of entered Azimuth (ref. to  
"TRAVERSE", page 216)  
Multiply  
Divide  
Add  
: Entering multiplication factor  
: Entering division factor  
: Entering angle for a correction to the  
right  
CO  
Subtract  
Azimuth  
: Entering angle for a correction to the  
left  
: Display of corrected Azimuth  
Accept displayed values and proceed to dialogue  
"TRAVERSE" (page 218).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Defining horizontal  
distance  
14:03  
COGO\  
TRAVERSE  
Distance to Traverse  
Horiz.Dist. :  
Offset  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
:
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz Dist  
Offset  
: Entering horizontal distance  
: Entering parallel displacement.  
Only active if "YES" is entered in the  
configuration during "Offset:"  
Left = negative parallel offset  
Right = positive parallel offset  
Determining the distance by means of the function  
"Polar calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering horizontal distance  
Call up of a distance which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
CO  
Accept displayed values and proceed to dialogue  
"TRAVERSE RESULTS" (page 220).  
Changing the distance (refer to dialogue "MODIFY  
DISTANCE", page 219).  
Exit the program.  
218  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
0.000 m  
-----  
COGO\ MODIFY DISTANCE  
Horiz.Dist. :  
Multiply  
Divide  
Add  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Subtract  
Horiz.Dist. :  
EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Dist.  
: Display of entered horizontal distance  
(refer to dialogue "TRAVERSE",  
page 218)  
Multiply  
Divide  
Add  
: Entering multiplication factor  
: Entering division factor  
CO  
: Entering distance for a positive  
correction  
Subtract  
: Entering distance for a negative  
correction  
Horiz.Dist.  
: Display of corrected horizontal  
distance  
Accept displayed values and proceed to dialogue  
"TRAVERSE RESULTS" (page 220).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the result of the  
traverse:  
14:03  
COGO\ TRAVERSE RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the point to  
be accepted  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
CO  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to "COGO MENU".  
Exit the program.  
220  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Intersections  
Call up the function from the "COGO MENU".  
14:03  
COGO\  
INTERSECTIONS  
Bearing - Bearing  
Bearing -Distance  
Distance-Distance  
End Intersections  
0
1
2
3
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
CO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bearing-Bearing  
Intersection  
Intersection  
positive parallel  
offset  
H
N
2
1
Azimuth  
E
Direction (here:  
Azimuth =  
Magnetic  
Magnetic  
bearing  
bearing)  
Search  
Given  
: • Coordinates of intersection  
(Y, X)  
: • point 1 (Y, X), direction (magnetic  
bearing or azimuth)  
• point 2 (Y, X), direction (magnetic  
bearing or azimuth)  
CO  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1 (and/or 2)  
can be determined by measurement.  
222  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the menu  
"INTERSECTIONS".  
14:03  
COGO\ BEARING #1 FROM  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first (second) point. The  
standard TPS 1000 input dialog box appears.  
Measuring the first (second) point of the straight line.  
This function is described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System" - user  
manual.  
CO  
Search for the coordinates of the first (second ) point in  
the coordinate file. This function is described in chapter  
"setups" (Import function) of the "System"-user  
manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Bearing" is selected in the configuration during  
"Direc. Type:", then the following dialog box appears:  
14:03  
Direction from first point  
COGO\  
BEARING #1  
Quadrant  
NorthEast  
Offset  
:
:
:
1
0°00'00"  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Quadrant  
: Enter quadrant (First or second  
straight lines)  
1 = Northeast  
2 = Southeast  
3 = Southwest  
4 = Northwest  
NorthEast  
: Enter magnetic bearing (First or  
second straight lines)  
If "Azimuth" is selected in the  
configuration during "Direc.Type:",  
then the azimuth of the first straight  
line (or the second straight line) can  
be entered.  
CO  
Offset  
: Entering parallel displacement.  
Only active if "YES" is entered in the  
configuration during "Offset:"  
Left = negative parallel offset  
Right = positive parallel offset  
Determining the direction by means of the function  
"Polar calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
224  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Enter bearing, mangnetic bearing resp.  
azimuth (if "Azimuth" is selected in  
the configuration during "Direc.  
Type:"  
Call up of a direction which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
BEARING", page 215 resp. "MODIFY AZIMUTH",  
page 217)  
Exit the program.  
CO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the result of the  
bearing-bearing intersection:  
14:03  
COGO\BRG-BRG RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the bearing-  
bearing  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
CO  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to "INTERSECTIONS".  
Exit the program.  
226  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bearing-Distance  
Intersection  
positive parallel  
offset  
H
N
S2  
S1  
2
Radius  
1
E
Direction (here:  
Azimuth = Magnetic  
bearing)  
CO  
Search  
Given  
: • Bearing-bearing coordinates  
S1 and S2 (Y, X)  
: • point 1 (Y, X), direction  
(magnetic bearing or azimuth)  
• point 2 (Y, X), radius  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1 (and/or 2)  
can be determined by measurement.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the menu  
"INTERSECTIONS".  
14:03  
COGO\ BEARING FROM  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first point (or circle centre  
point). The standard TPS 1000 input dialog box  
appears.  
Measuring the first point (or circle centre point). This  
function is described in chapter "Measure & Record"  
(Measurement dialogue) of the "System"-user manual.  
Search for the coordinates of the first point (or circle  
centre point) in the coordinate file. This function is  
described in chapter "Setups" (Import function) of the  
"System"-user manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
CO  
228  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Bearing" is selected in the configuration during  
"Direc. Type:", then the following dialog box appears:  
14:03  
COGO\BEARING-DISTANCE  
Direction from bearing point  
Quadrant  
NorthEast  
Offset  
:
:
:
1
0°00'00"  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Quadrant  
: Enter quadrant:  
1 = Northeast  
2 = Southeast  
3 = Southwest  
4 = Northwest  
CO  
NorthEast  
Offset  
: Enter magnetic bearing  
If "Azimuth" is selected in the  
configuration during "Direc. Type:",  
then the azimuth of the straight line  
can be entered.  
: Entering parallel displacement.  
Only active if "YES" is entered in the  
configuration during "Offset:"  
Left = negative parallel offset  
Right = positive parallel offset  
Determining the direction by means of the function  
"Polar calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Enter bearing, mangnetic bearing  
resp. azimuth (if "Azimuth" is  
selected in the configuration during  
"Direc. Type:"  
Call up of a direction which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
BEARING", page 215 resp. "MODIFY AZIMUTH",  
page 217)  
Exit the program.  
CO  
230  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter distance from point:  
14:03  
COGO\BEARING-DISTANCE  
Distance from point  
Horiz.Dist. :  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Dist.  
: Entering radius  
Determining the radius by means of the function "Polar  
calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
CO  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering radius  
Call up of a radius which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
DISTANCE", page219).  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the result of the  
bearing-distance intersection:  
14:03  
COGO\ BRG-DIST RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
OTHER STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the bearing-  
bearing  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
Changing between both solutions  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
CO  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to "INTERSECTIONS".  
Exit the program.  
232  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distance-Distance  
Intersection  
H
N
Radius 1  
S1  
1
2
S2  
E
Radius 2  
CO  
Search  
Given  
: • Bearing-bearing coordinates  
S1 and S2 (Y, X)  
: • point 1 (Y, X), radius 1  
• point 2 (Y, X), radius 2  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1 and/or 2  
can be determined by measurement.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the menu  
"INTERSECTIONS".  
14:03  
COGO\ DISTANCE #1 FROM  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first circle centre point (2nd  
circle centre point). The standard TPS 1000 input  
dialog box appears.  
Measuring the first circle centre point (2nd circle centre  
point). This function is described in chapter "Measure  
& Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System"-  
user manual.  
Search for the coordinates of the first circle centre point  
(2nd circle centre point) in the coordinate file. This  
function is described in chapter "Setup" (Import  
function) in the "System" - user manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
CO  
234  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter distance from points:  
14:03  
COGO\ DISTANCE-DISTANCE  
Distance from first point  
Horiz.Dist. :  
0.000 m  
RCALL EDIT  
INV  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Dist. : Entering distance from first point (2nd  
point)  
CO  
Determining the radius by means of the function "Polar  
calculation" (refer to chapter "Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering radius  
Call up of a radius which has been  
previously stored using the function  
"Polar calculation".  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
DISTANCE", page219).  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the result of the  
distance/distance intersection:  
14:03  
COGO\ DIST-DIST RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
OTHER STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the bearing-  
bearing  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
Changing between both solutions  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
CO  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to "INTERSECTIONS".  
Exit the program.  
236  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Offsets  
Call up the function in the "COGO MENU".  
14:03  
COGO\ OFFSETS  
Distance--Offset  
Set Point by Dist--Offset  
End Offsets  
0
1
2
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
CO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Distance-Offset  
H
N
Base point  
2
Q
L
3
1
E
Search  
Given  
: • Difference in length/abscissa (L)  
• Lateral deviation/ordinate (Q)  
• Base point coordinates (Y, X)  
: • Baseline Start Point 1 (Y, X),  
• Baseline End Point 2 (Y, X),  
• lateral point 3 (Y, X)  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1resp. 2  
and/or point 3 can be determined by measurement.  
CO  
Explanation of the polarity rule of L and Q  
During entering, the polarity is based on the straight  
line 1 -> 2.  
+ Q Parallel displacement to the right  
- Q Parallel displacement to the left  
+ L Displacement from basis point 1 in the direction  
of basis point 2  
- L Displacement from basis point 1 in the opposite  
direction to basis point 2  
238  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the menu "OFFSETS".  
14:03  
COGO\ BASELINE START PT.  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the baseline start point resp. the  
baseline end point (or the lateral point) . The standard  
TPS 1000 input dialog box appears.  
CO  
Measuring the baseline start point resp. the baseline end  
point (or the lateral point).This function is described in  
chapter "Measure & Record" (Measurement dialogue)  
of the "System"-user manual.  
Search for the coordinates of baseline start point resp.  
the baseline end point (or the lateral point) in the  
coordinate file. This function is described in chapter  
"Setup" (Import function) of the "System"-user manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the results:  
14:03  
COGO\ OFFSET RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Northing  
Elevation  
Distance  
Offset  
NEW STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the base  
point  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
Distance  
: Display difference in length/abscissa  
(L)  
Offset  
: Display lateral deviation/ordinate (Q)  
Entering the new lateral point with reference to the  
already existing basis line.  
CO  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
240  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to the menu "OFFSETS".  
Exit the program.  
Orthogonal point  
calculation  
H
N
2
CO  
Q
L
3
1
E
Search  
Given  
: • Lateral point 3 coordinates (Y, X)  
: • Baseline Start Point 1 (Y, X),  
• Baseline End Point 2 (Y, X),  
• Difference in length/abscissa (L)  
• Lateral deviation/ordinate (Q)  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1resp. point  
2 can be determined by measurement.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Explanation of the polarity rule of L and Q  
During entering, the polarity is based on the straight  
line 1 -> 2.  
+ Q Parallel displacement to the right  
- Q Parallel displacement to the left  
+ L Displacement from basis point 1 in the direction  
of basis point 2  
- L Displacement from basis point 1 in the opposite  
direction to basis point 2  
Call up the function in the menu "OFFSETS".  
14:03  
COGO\ BASELINE START PT.  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the baseline start point (or the  
baseline end point). The standard TPS 1000 input  
dialog box appears.  
CO  
Measuring the baseline start point (or the baseline end  
point). This function is described in chapter "Measure  
& Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System"-  
user manual.  
Search for the coordinates of baseline start point (or the  
baseline end point) in the coordinate file. This function  
is described in chapter "Setup" (Import function) of the  
"System"-user manual.  
or  
Exit the program.  
242  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter distance along baseline (L):  
14:03  
COGO\DISTANCE FROM START  
Distance along baseline  
Horiz.Dist. :  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
HELP  
MODIF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Dist. : Enter distance along baseline (L)  
CO  
Determining the distance along baseline (L) by means  
of the function "Polar calculation" (refer to chapter  
"Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering distance along baseline  
Call up of a distance along baseline  
which has been previously stored  
using the function "Polar  
calculation".  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
DISTANCE", page219).  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter lateral deviation/distance from start (Q):  
14:03  
Perpendicular offset from BL  
COGO\  
OFFSET  
Horiz.Dist. :  
0.000 m  
INV  
RCALL EDIT  
MODIF  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Horiz.Dist.  
: Enter lateral deviation/distance from  
start (Q)  
Determining the lateral deviation/distance from start  
(Q) by means of the function "Polar calculation" (refer  
to chapter "Inverse").  
INPUT  
RCALL  
Entering lateral deviation/distance  
from start  
Call up of a lateral deviation/distance  
from start which has been previously  
stored using the function "Polar  
calculation".  
CO  
Accept displayed values  
Changing the direction (as dialog box "MODIFY  
DISTANCE", page219).  
Exit the program.  
244  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the results of the  
orthogonal point calculation:  
14:03  
COGO\ OFFSET RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the lateral  
point  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
CO  
Northing  
Elevation  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to the menu "OFFSETS".  
Exit the program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Three Point Arc  
Circle  
centre  
H
N
2
3
1
Radius  
E
Search  
Given  
: • Circle centre coordinates  
(Y, X),  
• Radius  
: • Arc point 1 (Y, X),  
• Arc point 2 (Y, X),  
• Arc point 3 (Y, X)  
Station coordinates and orientation need to have been  
set correctly before the coordinates of point 1, 2 and/or  
point 3 can be determined by measurement.  
CO  
246  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call up the function from the "COGO MENU"  
14:03  
COGO\ FIRST PT ON ARC  
Rec. device : Memory Card  
Search in  
:
FILE01.GSI  
Point/Code :  
58  
INPUT  
HELP  
MEAS  
SEARC αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Manual entering of the first resp. the second resp. the  
third arc point. The standard TPS 1000 input dialog box  
appears.  
CO  
Measuring the first resp. the second resp. the third arc  
point. This function is described in chapter "Measure &  
Record" (Measurement dialogue) of the "System"-user  
manual.  
Search for the coordinates of the first resp. the second  
resp. the third arc point in the coordinate file. This  
function is described in chapter "Setup" (Import  
function) of the "System"-user manual.  
or  
Exit the program  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following dialog box shows the results of the  
calculation:  
14:03  
COGO\ RADIUS PT RESULTS  
Point no.  
Easting  
:
:
:
:
:
-----  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
-----  
Northing  
Elevation  
Radius  
0.000 m  
STORE  
STAKE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Point no.  
: Entering point number of the circle  
centre  
Easting  
: Display of east coordinate  
: Display of north coordinate  
: Entering height (optional)  
Northing  
Elevation  
The following results have been stored in the active  
measurement data file:  
WI 11  
WI 81  
WI 82  
WI 83  
Station Point Number  
Easting coordinate  
Northing coordinate  
Elevation (optional)  
CO  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Call up the program "Stakeout".  
The program "Plotting" assumes that the instrument is  
set and oriented to a known point.  
If "Point no." has not be entered, the button is not  
occupied.  
Return to the "COGO MENU".  
Exit the program.  
248  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Road Plus  
This manual describes the "ROADPLUS" program of  
the TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
Introduction  
The program allows for the stakeout of roads using the  
typical offset method of construction staking. In  
addition the program supports station equations, cross  
section assignment by station, cross section definition,  
cross section interpolation, superelevation, widening  
and slope staking/catch points.  
Alignment Definition  
An alignment consists of the three basic components  
which are horizontal alignment, vertical alignment and  
cross-section template. "ROADPLUS" reads the  
elements of each of these components from data files  
that are in GSI file format. In addition, a file can be  
created for entering cross-section stations for specific  
locations such as points needed for the staking of  
superelevation points. If station equations are needed,  
"ROADPLUS" will read a file created for station  
equations and apply the appropriate corrections.  
RP  
Data Files  
Each of the data files "ROADPLUS" reads contain the  
necessary information specific to the component being  
defined. The files have unique identifiers and must be in  
the GSI file format:  
Horizontal Alignment File  
Vertical Alignment File  
Template File  
ALN?????.GSI  
PRF?????.GSI  
CRS?????.GSI  
Cross-section Assignment File STA?????.GSI  
Station Equation File  
EQN?????.GSI  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The five identifiers ALN, PRF, CRS, STA and EQN  
identify the type of file and must be used when creating  
the data files. The ? can be any valid DOS character.  
The file extension GSI defines the file as a GSI file and  
must be used.  
1. Permitted elements in the Hz-alignment  
• Straight  
• Curve  
defined by chainage and  
coordinates of starting point  
defined by chainage and  
coordinates of starting point  
Radius of arc (- = left-hand curve;  
+ = right-hand curve)  
• Spiral  
defined by chainage and  
coordinates of starting point  
parameter A1 of spiral (negative  
parameter = spiral into left-hand  
curve)  
• Compound curve defined by chainage and  
coordinates of starting point  
Radius of arc (R1, R2)  
• End of project (EOP) chainage and coordinates of  
RP  
end-point  
1
A² = L x R where L = length of spiral; R = radius of  
curve  
250  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Permitted elements in V-alignments  
Straight  
Curve  
defined by chainage and height of  
starting point  
defined by chainage and height of  
starting point  
radius of arc (- = crest; + = dip)  
Parabola  
defined by chainage and height of  
starting point  
parameters of parabola2  
(- = crest; + = dip)  
End of project (EOP) chainage and height of end-  
point of gradient  
RP  
3. Permitted elements in cross sections  
Chainage  
Offset  
Height difference relative to axis  
2
2p x (H - H0) = (S - S0)²  
S0, H0 station and height of vertex  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Creating Data Files  
There are two methods that can be used to create the  
necessary data files. If the program called "FILE  
EDITOR" is loaded into the theodolite, all necessary  
data for a given component can be entered through the  
keyboard. To enter data on the computer a DOS pro-  
gram called "ROADDATA.EXE" can be used. If you  
create the files using the "ROADDATA.EXE" program,  
the files must be copied to the PCMCIA card in a  
directory called GSI.  
The following table shows an overview of the max. file  
sizes:  
Type of file  
Limitations  
Horizontal  
alignment  
No limitation for "RoadPlus";  
max. 200 blocks for "File Editor"  
Vertical  
alignment  
No limitation for "RoadPlus";  
max. 200 blocks for "File Editor"  
Cross section  
200 data blocks  
(number of points in a cross section  
max. 48)  
Cross section  
assignment  
100 data blocks  
Station equation 100 data blocks  
RP  
Program Overview  
"ROADPLUS" allows measurements in one telescope  
position only. A typical "ROADPLUS" session includes  
the following steps:  
1. Enter setup information for the instrument and orient.  
2. Start the ROADPLUS program and configure.  
3. Select the alignment files  
4. Select a station  
5. Pick a point on the cross-section to stakeout, enter an  
offset, choose method.  
252  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Stake the point and record the data.  
7. Choose another point on the cross-section and stake  
it out.  
8. When all selected points on the cross section have  
been staked, enter a new station and repeat steps 5-7.  
In the sections that follow, the operation of the program  
will be covered in more detail. The concepts of the  
program will be covered to assist you in becoming  
proficient with the "ROADPLUS" program for normal  
everyday operation such as staking a project with the  
Before starting the program, enter the setup information  
for the location of the theodolite and orient the  
instrument to the reference point.  
Getting Started  
From the "MAIN MENU: PROGRAMS" display, move  
the highlighted cursor to the "ROADPLUS" program  
RP  
and press  
on the keyboard of the instrument. This  
will bring up the "SELECT ALN FILES" display.  
The display illustration examples contain text and  
values for example purposes only. The actual values  
you will see on the display of your instrument will be  
different.  
14:03  
ALN_EX1  
ROAD+\ SELECT ALN FILES  
Horiz.Aln. :  
Vert. Aln. :  
Cross Secs :  
Crs.Assign :  
Station Eq :  
PRF_EX1  
CRS_EX1  
STA_EX1  
EQN_EX1  
Log FlName : ROADPLUS.LOG  
LIST  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Call up the "Configuration-Editor".  
Before selecting the alignment files to use, you should  
enter the configuration parameters for the job.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration  
Start the "Configuration-Editor" from the "SELECT  
ALN FILES" dialog.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CONFIGURATION  
Base Chainge:  
0.000  
End Chainge :  
89.270  
Chainge Incr:  
10.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght. Shift :  
Deflct. Tol.:  
Chainge Tol.:  
0°00'16"  
0.010 m  
INFO  
DFLT EDIT  
3D Stake  
:
ON  
OFF  
Crs.Intrpl. :  
Crs.Movemnt : Left > Right  
Hinge mode :  
normal  
ON  
ROAD.LOG  
Log File  
:
Log FlName :  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Base Chainge : Enter the beginning chainage for the  
project  
End Chainge : Enter the ending chainage for the  
project  
Chainge Incr : Enter the chainage interval to be used  
RP  
Hght. Shift : Enter a vertical shift value if needed.  
The value entered will be applied to  
the whole alignment.  
Deflct. Tol.  
: Enter an angle tolerance for deflection  
angles. Make this a small value but  
not 0.  
Chainge Tol. : Enter a value for chainage tolerance.  
This value will determine how close  
the point will be to a 0 location.  
3D Stake  
: Use the  
key to toggle between  
OFF or ON. For cut/fill capability this  
should be set to ON.  
254  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Crs. Intrpl. : The abbreviation means "Cross  
Section Interpolation". When this is  
set to ON, cross sections will be  
interpolated both along and between  
cross sections. The interpolation  
between cross sections makes  
superelevation and widening possible.  
If cross section interpolation is enabled, all cross  
sections must have the same number of points.  
Use the  
key to toggle between  
OFF and ON.  
Crs. Movemnt: This function controls the movement  
along the cross section.  
Press  
to display the movement  
options. There are three choices:  
LEFT to RIGHT, RIGHT to LEFT  
and NONE. The direction chosen is  
for display purposes only. The  
rodperson can go in any direction  
desired along the cross section.  
RP  
Hinge Mode : Normal: The points farest away from  
the axis are used for calculation of the  
slope piercing point.  
Not from End Pts: The points farest  
away from the axis are not used for  
calculation of the slope piercing point,  
i.e. the slope piercing point is already  
available in the cross section  
definition (catch point between digital  
ground pattern and cross section).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Log file  
: When the log file is set to ON, staked  
out data can be stored in a file for  
printing at al later date. Use the  
key to toggle between OFF and ON.  
Log FlName : Ente a file name for the log file. The  
default file name can be used.  
LogFlName appears only if "Log File  
= ON" is seledted in the  
"Configuration".  
Displays date and version of the program.  
Sets standard values. The values are displayed in dialog  
on page 253.  
Accepts and stores parameters displayed. Continues to  
display "SELECT ALN FILES"  
Select Alignment Files  
To proceed further, you must select a horizontal  
alignment file. The other files are optional and are  
dependent on what you are staking. For instance, if you  
are only staking the ”shape” of the road for clearing  
purposes, then it would not be necessary to have a  
vertical alignment, template, cross section assignment  
or station equation file. If your application requires  
these other files then you will need to select them.  
RP  
All alignment files must be stored in the memory card  
in the GIS directory.  
14:03  
ALN_EX1  
ROAD+\ SELECT ALN FILES  
Horiz. Aln.:  
Vert. Aln. :  
Cross Secs :  
Crs.Assign :  
Station Eq :  
PRF_EX1  
CRS_EX1  
STA_EX1  
EQN_EX1  
Log FlName : ROADPLUS.LOG  
LIST  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
256  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The horizontal alignment file contains the following  
elements:  
Horizontal Alignment  
File  
• Station locations  
• Straight line segments  
• Circular curves  
• Spiral curves  
• Compound curves  
• End of Project (EOP)  
Select the horizontal alignment file. A dialog box  
appears with a list of all ALN?????.GSI files available.  
Move the cursor to the file needed and press  
"SELECT ALN FILE" display will return and the  
cursor will be highlighting the vertical alignment file.  
. The  
The vertical alignment file contains the following  
elements:  
Vertical Alignment File  
• Station locations  
RP  
• Straight line segments  
• Circular vertical curves  
• Parabolic vertical curves  
• End of Project (EOP)  
Select the vertical alignment file. A dialog box appears  
with a list of all PRF?????.GSI files available. Move  
the cursor to the file needed and press  
"SELECT ALN FILE" display will return and the  
cursor will be highlighting the Cross Section file.  
. The  
The template file contains the following elements:  
• Station location  
Cross Section/template  
File  
• Template name  
• Offset from centerline  
• Difference in height from the  
centerline profile  
Select the cross section file. A dialog box appears with  
a list of all CRS?????.GSI files available. Move the  
cursor to the file needed and press  
. The "SELECT  
ALN FILE" display will return and the cursor will be  
highlighting the Cross section assignment file.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cross Section Definition  
When defining the cross section both a cut and fill  
template can be created similar to the following  
diagrams.  
Cross section - Cut  
CL  
Negative offset Positive offset  
Cross section - Fill  
CL  
RP  
Negative offset Positive offset  
CL ... Centerline  
258  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cross Section Assignment  
File  
The cross section assignment file contains the following  
elements:  
• Cross Section name  
• Starting Chainage  
A cross section assigned in this manner will remain in  
effect until another cross section is defined. When the  
file is created you designate the name of the template to  
use and the chainage to begin using the template. The  
next template name entered also contains a starting  
chainage. A third template can be assigned to begin at  
another chainage and so forth.  
For example, the file might contain the following  
information:  
XSEC1, 0  
XSEC2, 100  
XSEC3, 300  
XSEC1, 550  
RP  
The program would interpret this to use the template  
XSEC1 beginning at chainage 0 and end at chainage  
1+00, use XSEC2 beginning at chainage 1+00 and end  
at chainage 3+00, use XSEC3 from chainage 3+00 and  
transition back to XSEC1 ending at chainage 5+50.  
Select the cross section assignment file. A dialog box  
appears with a list of all STA?????.GSI files available.  
Move the cursor to the file needed and press  
.
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Cross Section Interpolation  
Cross sections can be interpolated both along the cross  
section i.e. between defined points, and between cross  
sections themselves. The interpolation between cross  
sections makes superelevtion and widening possible.  
The following diagrams illustrate these concepts.  
Interpolation along a cross section  
CL offset  
CL offset  
CL  
H  
H  
Interpolated point  
Last point  
on Xsec  
Interpolated point  
(horizontal)  
Interpolation between cross sections  
Cross Section B  
RP  
(with widening)  
150  
130  
100  
Interpolated Cross  
Section  
Cross Section A  
260  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Superelevation/Widening  
Superelevation is controlled by the cross sections.  
Cross sections must be placed at the appropriate  
chainage for the beginning of superelevation, full  
superelevation and back to no superelevation.  
The STA?????.GSI file contains these special locations  
for cross sections as well as cross section locations for  
widening. The diagram that follows illustrates the  
concept for superelevation.  
Superelvation governed by cross sections  
7.0  
D
RP  
C
CL  
B
Cross Section D  
Full Superelevation  
Cross Section C  
Intermediate  
5.5  
A
Cross Section B  
Intermediate  
Cross Section A  
No Superelevation  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station equations are used to adjust the alignment  
stationing. The most common reason for doing so is the  
insertion or removal of curves. Inserting or removing a  
curve would require re-calculating the stationing of an  
entire alignment. Using station equations eliminates  
this.  
Station Equation File  
new  
13  
12  
14  
8
15  
11  
10  
10 Station equations can create either a gap or overlap as  
shown in the following diagram.  
9
9
8
7
Forward Station Equation  
Station Back 10 + 000 = Station Ahead 15 + 000  
6
old  
7
5
6
1 2  
3
4
5 6  
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15  
4
5
3
2
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23  
1
10  
9
11  
12  
5
13  
7
8
Backward Station Equation  
Station Back 13 + 000 = Station Ahead 7 + 000  
old  
6
7
6
1 2  
3
4
5 6  
7
8
9 10 11 12 13  
new  
4
5
3
4
3
1 2  
3
4
5 6  
7
8
9 10 11 12  
2
2
1
RP  
Select the station equation file. A dialog box appears  
with a list of all EQN?????.GSI files available. Move  
the cursor to the file needed and press  
. The  
"SELECT ALN FILE" display will return and the  
cursor will be highlighting the Log Filename. The  
filename can be changed or the default name can be  
accepted.  
When all files have been selected. Continues to display  
"CHAINAGE & OFFSET". Prior to the "CHAINAGE  
& OFFSET" display appearing, you will see a brief  
message about checking for errors in the selected files.  
262  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
During the file checking process, each file is inspected  
for possible errors in the data format such as missing or  
incorrect word index. If errors are found, an error  
message is displayed indicating the type of error.  
During the inspection process, if any errors are found  
that would cause erroneous data to be computed and  
displayed, the file checking routine will be aborted. If  
this occurs, the file(s) containing the problem must be  
fixed before continuing. In addition to checking for file  
errors, geometrical components are checked. This  
includes tangent directions of adjacent elements and  
chord lengths of elements. Any deviations which exceed  
permitted tolerances are displayed such as in the  
following example.  
File Checking  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CHECKING FILES  
ALN: Deflection tolerance  
RP  
exceeded at chainage 1502.120.  
Difference in directions  
is 0"02'31". Override?  
NO  
YES  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Selecting the "NO" option to override will bring up  
another display that says "Continue checking  
alignment"? (no quotes). If you choose "NO" the  
display will return to the "SELECT ALN FILES" menu.  
If you choose "YES" the program will continue to  
check the other files. If no other errors are found the  
program will go to the opening "CHAINAGE &  
OFFSET" display.  
Selecting the "YES" option to override will cause the  
program to override the error and continue to check  
other files for possible errors. If no other errors are  
found the program will go to the "CHAINAGE &  
OFFSET" opening display.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The most common method for staking out roads,  
pavement, curb & gutter etc. is to use a horizontal offset  
from the actual point. For instance, a four foot offset  
from finished back of curb (BC) is commonly used to  
provide cut/fill stakes for a street and curb lines.  
Stakeout Using Horizon-  
tal Offset  
In this section of the manual, a sample project will be  
used to demonstrate the procedures to follow for  
staking a portion of the job. The project consists of a  
3 m wide paved bicycle path with a curve. The project  
will be staked on a 0.6 m offset from the edge of  
pavement. The POB and PC will be staked for both  
sides.  
Preparing for the  
example  
The example project for the TPS System  
"ROADPLUS" program consists of a simple horizontal  
and vertical alignment accompanied by a simple  
template. The project is designed to illustrate the  
application of the "ROADPLUS" System. It is not  
intended to provide a demonstration of road design  
procedures.  
3.0  
1.15  
RP  
Setup Point  
N
0.6  
264  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our bike path is about 30 m in length as illustrated here.  
The riding surface is 3 m wide, lying 1.5 m on each side  
of the centerline. From the edge of the driving surface,  
fill slopes extend downward at a slope of 2:1.  
The vertical alignment (or profile) for the project is a  
simple 2% uphill slope. An assumed elevation of 30.50  
is placed on the original ground at the Setup Point, and  
the road starts at elevation 31.1. This allows you to  
practice with all of the components of the  
"ROADPLUS" program. For the field work, we  
recommend a flat, open area about 25 m on a side.  
The following pages contain illustrations and listings of  
all the data needed to run the example.  
There are 3 easy steps to the example:  
RP  
1. Use the "ROADDATA.EXE" program on your  
PC to enter the design information for the Hori-  
zontal Alignment, Vertical Alignment, and  
Templates.  
A special naming convention identifies the type of  
file that each alignment and template are stored in.  
The first three letters in the file name tell  
"ROADPLUS" what is in the file and how to view it.  
The GSI extension is also required.  
Horizontal Alignment: ALN?????.GSI  
Vertical Alignment:  
Templates:  
PRF?????.GSI  
CRS?????.GSI  
In "ROADDATA.EXE", enter the following example  
project data. Let’s call the project "EXAMPLE" and  
configure the units to m, 3 decimal places. Let’s name  
the files "ALN_EX1.GSI", "PRF_EX1.GSI", and  
"CRS_EX1.GSI".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E: 305.000  
N: 320.240  
PI  
CHA=0+15.240  
I=80°00'00"  
T=7.620  
R=9.087  
L=12.680  
C=11.674  
E=2.774  
M=2.125  
E: 320.007  
N: 322.885  
C = 11.674  
L = 12.680  
E = 2.774  
M = 2.125  
80°00'00"  
(88.889 gon)  
PC CHA=0+7.62  
0+6.10  
R = 9.080  
N
Setup Point  
E: 314.15  
N: 308.05  
H: 30.50  
0+00  
E: 305.00  
N: 305.00  
H: 31.10  
3
0
3
6
9 m  
BOP CHA=0+00  
BOP EL=31.10  
EOP  
Road Profile at 2.00%  
CHA=0+27.918  
EOP EL=31.654  
RP  
Original Ground of Elevation 30.500  
Horizontal Alignment: ALN_EX1.GSI  
Station  
Element  
Rad/Par  
Template  
E
N
0.000  
7.620  
20.298  
27.918  
Straight  
Curve  
Straight  
EOP  
0.000  
9.080  
0.000  
0.000  
Tutor  
Tutor  
Tutor  
Tutor  
305.000  
305.000  
312.502  
320.007  
305.000  
312.620  
321.562  
322.885  
266  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vertical Alignment : PRF_EX1.GSI  
Chainage  
Element  
Rad/Par  
H
1
2
0
Straight  
EOP  
0
0
31.100  
31.654  
27.918  
Template: CRS_EX1.GSI  
The horizontal alignment file specifies a template for  
each chainage. Our horizontal alignment file specifies  
only one template, "TUTOR". You can, however,  
specify different templates for any chainage as you may  
require. We will define two templates, "TUTOR" and  
"TYP_CUT", in our template file. Notice that while  
running "ROADPLUS", you can switch templates at  
any time.  
RP  
-1.5, -0.03  
0, 0  
1.5, -0.03  
CL  
Original Ground  
-35, -16.7  
35, -16.7  
Slope extends well beyond expected Catch Point  
Template  
sCLO  
s H  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Tutor  
Tutor  
Tutor  
Tutor  
-35.000  
-1.500  
0.000  
-16.700  
-0.030  
0.000  
-0.030  
-16.700  
-16.630  
-0.030  
0.000  
1.500  
Tutor  
35.000  
-35.000  
-1.500  
0.000  
1.500  
35.000  
TypCut  
TypCut  
TypCut  
TypCut  
-0.030  
-16.630  
10 TypCut  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Copy the alignment and template files to your  
PCMCIA card. Copy the files into the GSI  
subdirectory on your PCMCIA card. If the GSI  
subdirectory doesn’t already exist on the PCMCIA  
card, you will need to create one. Place the PCMCIA  
card in your instrument.  
3. Set up the instrument in your work area and  
stakeout the example roadway. Set the instrument  
coordinates to the values shown for point 1 (see  
figure page 264). Orient the instrument towards a  
convenient "North", and set Hzo to zero (see figure  
page 264). Start "ROADPLUS" and continue reading  
this manual.  
When the "CHAINAGE & OFFSET" display appears,  
only the lower portion beginning with "Station" will be  
visible. To view the entire display, use the green up/  
down arrow keys on the keyboard to scroll up to the  
top.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CHAINAGE & OFFSET  
Hght. Shift :  
Chainge Incr :  
0.000 m  
25.000  
0.000  
Chainge  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
:
POB  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght Offset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
EDIT  
HELP STORE StaEq NOTE  
RP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Hght. Shift : Vertical shift applied to the whole  
alignment.  
Chainge Incr : The chainage increment set in the  
configuration is displayed. If desired,  
a new value can be entered.  
Chainage  
: Enter the chainage location for the  
points to be staked.  
268  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Element  
Offset  
: This displays the element for the  
chosen chainage such as POB, PC,  
CURVE etc.  
: Horizontal offset to apply to the  
current chainage.  
Hght Offset : Vertical offset to apply to the current  
chainage.  
Switches to measuring mode to allow for a  
measurement to determine the chainage and offset for  
the point shot. After taking the measurement, press  
and the program will return to the "CHAINAGE  
& OFFSET" opening display. The chainage value of  
where the shot was taken along with the horizontal and  
vertical offset are displayed.  
Changes to the next chainage.  
RP  
Changes to the previous chainage.  
Activates the cross section options.  
The result of the road chainage and offset is stored. Just  
active after taking a measurement.  
Activates the "Station Equation" option. Active only if a  
"Station Equation File" is selected during display  
"SELECT ALN FILES" (page 254).  
Allows insertion of a note into a log file. This may be  
use for comments, errors, etc.  
Calls the dialog "POINT COORDS" in order to display  
the coordinates of the point to be set out. From there,  
calls the program "STAKEOUT".  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The first step in the procedure is to select a point on the  
cross section to be staked and enter the offset.  
Select Template point and  
offset  
Access the cross section options.  
14:03  
1L  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
:
0.000  
Hght. Shift :  
0.000 m  
Template  
:
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
-1.500 m  
-0.030 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
Stake Offs. :  
-0.600 m  
S.Offset Ht : Horizontal  
Offset  
:
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght Offset :  
HELP  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1L  
: Indicates the location of the cross  
section point in relation to the  
centerline. In this example, the "1L"  
means the first point of the template  
left of centerline.  
Chainage  
: Displays the current chainage.  
RP  
Hght. Shift : Displays the vertical shift, if any,  
applied to the whole alignment.  
Template  
: Displays the template name being  
used.  
CL Offset : Displays the horizontal distance of the  
template point from centerline (- for  
left)  
CL Hgt Diff : Displays the difference in elevation of  
the template point between the  
centerline and the point to be staked.  
270  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stake Offs. : This is the offset value that will be  
used for setting the offset stake. If the  
point is left of centerline, the value  
entered must be a negative number.  
S. Offset Ht : This display indicates the method used  
in computing the elevation of the point  
to be staked. The three methods are  
"PREVIOUS ELEMENT",  
"INTERPOLATED" and  
"HORIZONTAL".  
Offset  
: Horizontal offset to apply to current  
chainage.  
Hght Offset : Vertical offset to apply to current  
chainage.  
RP  
Activates the slope staking options  
Move along the current cross section from right to left.  
Sets the cross section point to the centerline  
Move across the current cross section from left to right  
Displays a plot of the template.  
The first point we want to stake for the bike path is the  
left edge of pavement. This point is 1.5 m left of  
centerline so the "CL Offset" value should be set to  
a -1.5 m.  
Change the location to -1.5 m. The "CL Hght Diff"  
value will automatically change to the correct vertical  
difference based upon the design of the template.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The offset value needs to be set to a -0.600 m. The  
negative value is used because the point to stake is left  
of centerline.  
To accept the value press  
.
The final step in the process is to select the method to  
use for computing the elevation of the offset point to be  
staked. The "ROADPLUS" program provides three  
methods to choose from:  
Horizontal  
- The elevation is computed  
horizontally to the catch point.  
Previous Element - The elevation is computed on an  
extension of the grade of the  
previous element.  
Interpolated  
- The elevation is interpolated to  
intersect the design slope of the  
cross section.  
The following illustration shows the three vertical  
options for stake offset.  
RP  
Stake Offset  
1 Horizontal  
1
2
2 Previous Element  
3 Interpolated  
3
272  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The most common method used is the "HORIZON-  
TAL" method.  
To select this method, move the cursor to "S. Offset Ht"  
and press  
to display the three options.  
Move the cursor to "HORIZONTAL" and press  
.
This setting will remain as the current method until a  
different method is chosen. Therefore it is not necessary  
to go through the procedure every time.  
Accepts and stores parameters set. Continues to display  
"POINT COORDS".  
The "POINT COORDS" dialog displays the current  
chainage location of the offset point to be staked. The  
display also shows the value for the prism pole (Refl.  
Height) and the Easting and Northing coordinates of the  
offset point and the finished grade elevation of the  
actual point (not the offset location).  
Stakeout and Record  
point  
RP  
14:03  
0.000  
1.500 m  
331.000 m  
335.000 m  
31.000 m  
ROAD+\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage  
:
Refl.Height:  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
STAKE EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Activates the stakeout program  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
3
STAKE\ POLAR STAKEOUT  
Target no. :  
Hz  
:
0°00'00"  
Dist  
Height  
:
0.007 m  
1.320 m  
32.700 m  
:FILL  
Elevation :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The polar method of stakeout is the default for  
"ROADPLUS".  
Turn the instrument until "Hz" is zero.  
Line up the prism pole.  
Measure the distance.  
The "Dist" value indicates how far away the  
measured point is from the point chosen to be staked. A  
positive value means to move away from the instrument  
by the amount shown. If the value is negative, move  
towards the instrument. The display will also show the  
cut or fill value for the measured point. When both the  
horizontal circle and distance read zero or close to it,  
the measurement can be recorded.  
Record the staked out position, returns to the "CROSS  
SECTIONS" display and automatically moves to the  
next point on the cross section.  
RP  
274  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout Next point on Cross Section  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
1R  
Chainage  
Template  
:
:
0.000  
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
1.500 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
-0.030 m  
Stake Offs. :  
0.600 m  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
To set the offset stake for the right side of our example  
project:  
Set the "CL Offset" value to positive 1.500 m.  
Note when you do this the position changes from "1L"  
to "1R". Scroll down and highlight "Stake Offs.".  
Change the offset value to positive 0.600 m.  
RP  
Returns to the "POINT COORDS" display.  
14:03  
0.000  
1.500 m  
331.000 m  
335.000 m  
31.000 m  
ROAD+\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage  
:
Refl.Height:  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
STAKE EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Stakeout the 0.600 m offset stake for the right side of  
the bike path. The "POLAR STAKEOUT" display  
returns.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
4
STAKE\ POLAR STAKEOUT  
Target no. :  
Hz  
:
0°00'00"  
Dist  
Height  
:
0.007 m  
1.320 m  
32.700 m  
:FILL  
Elevation :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Measures the distance.  
Record the point when it has been staked. The "CROSS  
SECTION" display returns showing the next point on  
the cross section to stake.  
14:03  
1R  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
Template  
:
:
0.000  
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
1.500 m  
-0.030 m  
0.600 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
Stake Offs. :  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RP  
For this example, the last point staked was the 0.600 m  
offset point for the right side. When the "CROSS  
SECTIONS" display appears, the "CL Offset" changes  
to the next point on the cross section. The next point to  
stake is the 0.600 m offset for the right side at the next  
station.  
Exits from the "CROSS SECTIONS" display and  
returns to the "CHAINAGE & OFFSET".  
276  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CHAINAGE & OFFSET  
Chainage  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
:
0.000  
POB  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght Offset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
HELP  
EDIT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Moves to the next chainage (you also may enter a  
chainage). The chainage and offset display will change  
to reflect the new chainage location.  
Brings up the "CROSS SECTIONS" display.  
RP  
14:03  
1R  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
Template  
:
:
25.000  
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
1.500 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
-0.030 m  
Stake Offs. :  
0.600 m  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
In our example the last point staked was on the right  
side. Rather than have the rod person cross back over to  
the left side, it makes sense to stay on the right side and  
stake that position and then cross over to the left side.  
To stake the catch point on the right side:  
Set the "CL Offset" from centerline value to positive  
1.500 m. The offset value should be positive 0.600 m,  
but should not require a change because that was the  
last offset value used for the previous right side point.  
Access the "POINT COORDS" display.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage  
:
25.000  
Refl.Height:  
1.500 m  
337.000 m  
340.500 m  
31.200 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
STAKE EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
To stake the offset point on the right side for chainage  
25+00:  
Activates the stakeout program. The "POLAR  
STAKEOUT" display will appear.  
14:03  
5
STAKE\ POLAR STAKEOUT  
Target no. :  
Hz  
:
0°00'00"  
Dist  
Height  
:
0.010 m  
0.950 m  
33.187 m  
:FILL  
Elevation :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RP  
Use the normal procedure previously outlined for  
staking out the point.  
Records the staked out position and returns to the  
"CROSS SECTIONS" display.  
278  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
1L  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
Template  
:
:
25.000  
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
-1.500 m  
-0.030 m  
-0.600 m  
CL Hgt Diff:  
Stake Offs. :  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Change the "CL Offset" from centerline to negative  
1.5 m. Change the "Stake Offs." value to negative  
0.600 m.  
Access the "POINT COORDS" display.  
RP  
14:03  
ROAD+\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage  
:
25.000  
Refl.Height:  
1.500 m  
331.000 m  
340.500 m  
31.200 m  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
STAKE EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Access the stakeout program. Follow the stakeout  
procedure previously outlined and record the staked out  
point. When the "CROSS SECTIONS" display returns,  
press  
display.  
to access the "CHAINAGE & OFFSET"  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In this section, a brief summary of using the horizontal  
offset method is provided. It is assumed the reader has  
reviewed sections "Stakeout using horizontal offset"  
through "Stakeout and recording" which provide a  
detailed explanation of program functions. We  
recommend making a copy of this short guide and  
keeping it in the instrument case.  
Horizontal Offset Stake  
Out Summary  
Start the "ROADPLUS" from the program menu.  
Start ROADPLUS & Set  
Configuration Options  
Start the "Configuration-Editor" from the "SELECT  
ALN FILES" dialog.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CONFIGURATION  
Base Chainge:  
0.000  
End Chainge :  
89.270  
Chainge Incr:  
10.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght. Shift :  
Deflct. Tol.:  
Chainge Tol.:  
0°00'20"  
0.010 m  
INFO  
DFLT EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RP  
Enter the beginning and ending chainage, the chainage  
increment and so forth. Make all entries.  
Returns to the "SELECT ALN FILES" display.  
280  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select Alignment Files  
14:03  
ALN_EX1  
ROAD+\ SELECT ALN FILES  
Horiz. Aln.:  
Vert. Aln. :  
Cross Secs :  
Crs.Assign :  
Station Eq :  
PRF_EX1  
CRS_EX1  
STA_EX1  
EQN_EX1  
Log FlName : ROADPLUS.LOG  
LIST  
HELP CONF  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Select the alignment files.  
Place the cursor on each file type, press  
and pick  
RP  
the file from the displayed list. Select the files.  
The "CHAINAGE & OFFSET" options are displayed.  
A horizontal file must be selected.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Set offset value and select  
point to stakeout  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CHAINAGE & OFFSET  
Chainage  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
:
0.000  
POB  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght Offset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
HELP  
EDIT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
To select the template point to stake (back of curb, edge  
of pavement etc.):  
The "CROSS SECTIONS" options display appears.  
14:03  
1R  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
Template  
:
:
25.000  
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
1.500 m  
-0.030 m  
0.600 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
Stake Offs. :  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
RP  
Set the "CL Offset" value. This value is the distance  
from centerline of the point you want to stake.  
Move the cursor to "Template" and pick the cross  
section template to use. Following set the "Stake Offs."  
(stake offset value). If the point is left of the centerline,  
enter the offset value as a negative value.  
or  
Continues with display "POINT COORDS".  
282  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stakeout the point  
14:03  
0.000  
1.500 m  
331.000 m  
335.000 m  
31.000 m  
ROAD+\ POINT COORDS  
Chainage  
:
Refl.Height:  
Easting  
:
:
Northing  
Elevation :  
STAKE EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The stakeout program will start with the polar stakeout  
method being used.  
14:03  
4
STAKE\ POLAR STAKEOUT  
Target no. :  
Hz  
:
:
0°00'00"  
Dist  
Height  
0.007 m  
1.320 m  
32.700 m  
:FILL  
RP  
Elevation :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP METHD PLOT  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
With the polar method, the theodolite is turned until the  
displayed horizontal circle reading is zero degrees. The  
rod person is moved on line and a distance is measured.  
The results are displayed telling you how far from the  
real point the prism pole is. Move the rodperson until  
the distance shows near zero. The CUT/FILL value is  
displayed along with the elevation of the point.  
Record the point, and the "CROSS SECTIONS" display  
returns.  
Move to a new chainage. The "CHAINAGE & OFF-  
SET" display returns.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select new chainage  
14:03  
ROAD+\ CHAINAGE & OFFSET  
Chainage  
Element  
Offset  
:
:
:
0.000  
POB  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Hght Offset :  
CHECK CH--> <--CH XSEC  
HELP  
EDIT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Select a new chainage (you also may enter a chainage).  
Select the point to stake out and the offset.  
Repeat the procedure outlined in sections "Set offset  
value and select point to stakeout" (page 282) through  
"Select new chainage" (page 284). Continue in this  
manner until all points have been staked.  
RP  
284  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Slope staking involves determining a point where the  
cross section template meets the ground surface. This  
point of zero cut/fill is found primarily by trial and error  
and a lot of computing. The following diagram  
illustrates the concepts of slope staking.  
Slope Staking  
CL Offset  
FILL  
Cross  
Section  
XS Hgt Diff  
Catch Point  
RP  
Chainage  
0+200.000  
Plan View  
CUT  
CL Offset  
Catch Point  
Cross  
Section  
XS Hgt Diff  
Chainage  
0+200.000  
Plan View  
The slope staking routine is accessed from the "CROSS  
SECTIONS" display.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start the "CROSS SECTIONS" display from the  
"CHAINAGE & OFFSET" display.  
14:03  
1L  
ROAD+\ CROSS SECTIONS  
Chainage  
:
0.000  
Hght. Shift :  
0.000 m  
Template  
:
+000tutor  
CL Offset :  
-1.500 m  
-0.030 m  
CL Hgt Diff :  
CATCH <- CENTR ->  
HELP  
PLOT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Before proceeding, move the cursor to the "Template"  
option.  
Choose the template to use for slope staking. If the  
displayed template is the correct one, then it will not be  
necessary to change it.  
Start the slope stake program.  
14:03  
ROAD+\ SLOPE STAKING  
Chainage  
Template  
Xsection  
:
:
:
0.000  
typcut  
CUT  
9.867 m  
1.089 m  
3.254 m  
CL Offset :  
RP  
XS Hgt Diff :  
Chainage  
:
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
HELP St=0 STORE I<>II REFPT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
The "STORE" and "REFPT" options are not  
available until after a measurement is taken.  
286  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measure to the current position of the prism pole.  
The value for "XS Hgt Diff" needs to be zero or close  
to it. When this value is zero the catch point has been  
determined. However, the value for "Chainage" is also  
important. This value shows where the actual point is in  
relation to the chainage of the cross section being used.  
In the sample display shown, the value for "XS Hgt  
Diff" is 1.089 m. The value is positive which means the  
catch point is higher than where the measurement was  
taken. Therefore the rodperson would look for a spot  
that is approximately 1 m higher than the current point.  
Now look at the value for "Chainage". This indicates  
where the prism pole is in relation to the chainage. In  
this example, the rodperson would move approximately  
3 m to his/her right looking towards the instrument. If  
the value is negative the pole would be moved to the  
left.  
RP  
In addition, the horizontal distance from centerline is  
displayed which is 9.867 m for this example.  
After moving to a new location, measure a distance to  
the prism and view the results. When the "XS Hgt  
Diff" and "Station" are at or near zero the catch point  
has been located both vertically and horizontally for the  
chosen chainage.  
Record the staked out position.  
The "SLOPE STAKING" display returns and another  
catch point can be staked.  
Exit the slope staking program.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SLOPE STAKING Menu Function Key Summary  
Measures the distance to the target, and automatically  
records the data as defined by the currently set  
recording mask.  
Measures the distance only, and updates the display.  
Records the information for the current measurements.  
Permits the user to change the height of the target.  
Stores the data to the log file.  
The store function is not available until a  
measurement is initiated with the "DIST" key.  
Switches between face one and face two for  
measurements.  
After a measurement is made to the prism pole the  
"REFPT" option will be available. See section  
"Reference Point" for a detailed discussion of this  
option.  
Moves along the alignment until "Chainage" =0, that  
is, move onto the correct cross section defined for that  
point. This allows checking against the actual cross  
section defined at that point.  
RP  
The "St=0" function is not available until a  
measurement is initiated with the "DIST" key.  
288  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference Point  
Displays additional information about how the location  
of the prism pole relates to components of the cross-  
section. Do this after a measurement has been made.  
14:03  
1L  
ROAD+\ REFERENCE POINT  
Chainage  
Template  
Chainage  
:
:
:
0.000  
typcut  
3.254 m  
-0.347 m  
-0.389 m  
Catch Offs :  
Catch HgtD :  
ALL DIST REC TARGT  
Hinge Offs :  
Hinge HgtD :  
CL Offset :  
CL HgtDiff :  
8.154 m  
-2.123 m  
9.213 m  
-1.124 m  
RP  
HELP  
STORE I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1L  
: Indicates the location of the cross  
section point in relation to the  
centerline. In this example, the "1L"  
means the first point of the template  
left of centerline.  
Chainage  
Template  
: Displays the current chainage.  
: Displays the template name being  
used.  
Chainage  
: Displays where the rod is in relation to  
the actual chainage. Move the rod to  
the right as you are looking from the  
pole towards the instrument if the  
value is positive. If the value is  
negative move to the left.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Catch Offs : This value is where the pole is in  
relation to where the existing ground  
intersects the design slope of the  
template.  
Catch HgtD : This value is the vertical difference  
from the ground shot to where the  
existing ground catches the template.  
Hinge Offs : This is the horizontal distance from  
the prism to where the template begins  
the slope (hinges).  
Hinge HgtD : The vertical difference between the  
ground shot and the hinge point.  
CL Offset : The horizontal distance from the  
ground shot to the centerline.  
CL HgtDiff : The vertical distance from the ground  
shot to the centerline.  
The following illustration represents the various  
components of the REFPT option.  
RP  
Catch Offs  
Hinge Offs  
CL Offset  
290  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Data Formats  
The following describes the format and contents of the  
data stored for alignments and cross-sections in the  
RoadPlus program. All files are in GSI format and must  
be located in the \GSI directory of the memory card.  
Horizontal Alignment  
The following geometric elements are supported:  
Element  
Definition  
Declaration in the  
alignment file  
Tangent  
Coordinates (X,Y) to Coordinates (X,Y)  
"STRAIGHT"  
Circular curve Beginning of arc (X,Y), Radius,  
"000CURVE"  
End of arc (X,Y);  
Spiral In  
Beginning of curve (X,Y), A-Parameter / "00SPIRIN"  
Length of curve + Radius,  
End of curve (X,Y);  
RP  
Spiral out  
Beginning of curve (X,Y), A-Parameter / "0SPIROUT"  
Length of curve + Radius,  
End of curve (X,Y);  
Compound  
curve in  
Beginning of curve (X, Y), Radius 1,  
Radius 2  
"0CURVEIN"  
"CURVEOUT"  
"00000EOP"  
Compound  
curve out  
Beginning of curve (X, Y), Radius 1,  
Radius 2  
End of Project Coordinates (X,Y)  
Header of the Horizontal Alignment File:  
41....+000JOBID 42....+HZALIGNM 43......+STACOORD  
WI 41 Job-Identification. Max. 8 ASCII-characters,  
may be defined by user.  
WI 42 Identification of Horizontal Alignment file.  
May not be changed by user.  
WI 43 Identification of principal point type file. May  
not be changed by user.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The data block for a principal point in the file is  
structured as follows :  
11....+KILOMETR 71....+0NEXTGEO 72....+0NEXTRAD  
73....+0TEMPLNR 81..10+00000000 82..10+00000000  
WI 11 Chainage of the point.  
WI 71 Type of the following geometric element.  
WI 72 Radius of the next horizontal geometric  
element, Radius 1 for a compound curve, or  
the A-Parameter for spirals.  
WI 73 Number of a cross-section (Template) assigned  
to the next geometric element.  
WI 74 Radius 2 for compound curves.  
WI 81 E-Coordinate of the point.  
WI 82 N-Coordinate of the point.  
Comments:  
• The header consists of a single block at the start of a  
data file.  
• Tangents and the EOP contain “00000NON” in  
WI72  
• Data units in WI’s 11 and 72 are defined by WI81  
and WI82.  
• If the radius point for a curve (circular or spiral) is to  
the left of the alignment in the direction of increasing  
stations, the radius is negative.  
• If the radius point for a curve (circular or spiral) is to  
the right of the alignment in the direction of  
increasing stations, the radius is positive.  
• The same cross section (Template) may be assigned  
to more than one location.  
RP  
• An alignment file must contain at least two elements.  
• There is no limitation on the size of the Hz-alignment  
file. As a result, as many data blocks as you like can  
be entered if a file is created on the PC using the  
DOS program "ROADDATA.EXE". If a file is  
created/edited using the program "FILE EDITOR"  
on the TPS1000 there is a limitation of 200 data  
blocks.  
292  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example of a Horizontal Alignment:  
41....+0EXAMPLE 42....+HZALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
11....+00000000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
73....+QP000125 81..10+06000000 82..10+02000000  
11....+00198832 71....+00SPIRIN 72....-00122474  
73....+QP000123 81..10+06068005 82..10+02186841  
11....+00348832 71....+000CURVE 72....-00100000  
73....+QP000123 81..10+06150344 82..10+02307751  
11....+00450725 71....+0SPIROUT 72....-00100000  
73....+QP000123 81..10+06247816 82..10+02304071  
11....+00550725 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
73....+QP000125 81..10+06310759 82..10+02227794  
11....+00714138 71....+00SPIRIN 72....+00054772  
73....+QP000124 81..10+06392465 82..10+02086275  
11....+00789138 71....+000CURVE 72....+00040000  
73....+QP000124 81..10+06445859 82..10+02037807  
11....+00824376 71....+0SPIROUT 72....+00044721  
73....+QP000124 81..10+06478120 82..10+02048886  
11....+00874376 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
73....+QP000125 81..10+06496445 82..10+02094478  
11....+01127904 71....+00000EOP 72....+00000NON  
73....+QP000125 81..10+06540469 82..10+02344154  
RP  
The principal points method allows joining elements  
without the use of intermediate tangents.  
The following combinations, for example, may be  
defined:  
Double spiral: spiral out followed by spiral in  
Multiple circular curves  
S curves with and without intermediate tangents  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Geometric elements supported:  
Vertical Alignment  
Element  
Definition  
Declaration in the  
Alignment file  
Tangent  
Coordinate (Km,H) to Coordinate (Km,H) "STRAIGHT"  
Circular curve beginning of curve(Km,H), Radius,  
end of curve (Km,H);  
"000CURVE"  
Parabola  
Coordinate (Km,H), Parabola parameter / "0PARABOL"  
Parabola length;  
End of project Coordinate (Km,H)  
"00000EOP"  
Vertical Alignment File Header:  
41....+000JOBID 42....+0VALIGNM 43......+STACOORD  
WI 41 Job-Identification. Max. 8 ASCII-characters,  
may be defined by user.  
WI 42 Identification of Vertical Alignment file. May  
not be changed by user.  
WI 43 Identification of principal point type file. May  
not be changed by user.  
RP  
Example for a data block for a vertical alignment  
point:  
11....+KILOMETR 71....+0NEXTGEO 72....+0NEXTRAD 83..10+00000000  
WI 11 Chainage of a vertical alignment point  
WI71  
WI72  
Type of the following geometric element  
Radius of the following geometric element or  
parabola parameter  
WI83  
Elevation of the point  
294  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Comments:  
• The header consists of a single block at the start of a  
data file.  
• Tangents and the EOP contain “00000NON” in  
WI72  
• Data units in WI’s 11, and 72 are defined by WI83.  
• Tangent and arc lengths may be calculated from the  
stationing.  
• The stationing is projected onto a horizontal plane.  
• If the curve radius point lies above the centerline, the  
radius is positive.  
• If the curve radius lies beneath the centerline, the  
radius is negative.  
• An alignment file must contain at least two elements.  
• There is no limitation on the size of the V-alignment  
file. As a result, as many data blocks as you like can 
be entered if a file is created on the PC using the  
DOS program "ROADDATA.EXE". If a file is  
created/edited using the program "FILE EDITOR"  
on the TPS1000 there is a limitation of 200 data  
blocks.  
RP  
Example of a vertical alignment file:  
41....+0EXAMPLE 42....+0VALIGNM 43....+STACOORD  
11....+00000000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
83..10+00400000  
11....+00300000 71....+0PARABOL 72....-01142932  
83..10+00422500  
11....+00500000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
83..10+00420000  
11....+00550000 71....+0PARABOL 72....+02091126  
83..10+00415000  
11....+00850000 71....+STRAIGHT 72....+00000NON  
83..10+00406522  
11....+01127904 71....+00000EOP 72....+00000NON  
83..10+00418605  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Geometric elements supported:  
Cross Sections  
Element  
Height differences Height difference to the centerline  
Distance Distance from the centerline  
Definition  
Cross section type Differentiate between CUT and  
FILL cross sections  
Slope  
slope ratio  
Header of the cross section file:  
41....+00JOB_ID 42....+TEMPLATE  
WI41 Job identification. Max. 8 ASCII characters,  
user definable.  
WI42 Template file identification. May not be  
changed by user.  
A data block for a cross section is structured as  
follows:  
11....+ PROF_NR 35....+DISTANCE 36....+000HDIFF  
WI 11 The cross section number.  
WI 35 Horizontal distance from the centerline.  
WI 36 Height difference from the centerline.  
WI 71 Cross section type.  
RP  
WI 72 Slope ratio.  
Comments:  
• The header consists of a single block at the start of a  
data file.  
• All data blocks having the same cross section  
number (WI11) belong together.  
• All data blocks belonging to a cross section must be  
consecutive in the file to minimize file access.  
• The data blocks for a cross section must be sorted by  
ascending distance from the centerline.  
296  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• Cross-sections do not have to be sorted by number.  
• A negative distance (WI35) indicates a point to the  
left of the centerline.  
• A positive distance (WI35) indicates a point to the  
right of the centerline.  
• A negative height difference (WI36) indicates a point  
below the centerline.  
• A positive height difference (WI36) indicates a point  
above the centerline.  
• For a cross section file there is a limitation of 200  
data blocks. The maximum number of points in a  
cross section is 48.  
• A template file must contain at least one cross-section.  
• The entries for cross section type and slope are  
optional.  
• The slope entry must be attached to the last point on  
either side of the cross section.  
Example:  
RP  
41....+0EXAMPLE 42....+TEMPLATE  
11....+QP000123 35..10-00013000 36..10-00003000  
11....+QP000123 35..10-00010000 36..10-00005000  
11....+QP000123 35..10-00004000 36..10-00000100  
11....+QP000123 35..10+00004000 36..10+00000100  
11....+QP000123 35..10+00010000 36..10-00006000  
11....+QP000123 35..10+00013000 36..10-00003500  
11....+QP000124 35..10-00012000 36..10-00002000  
11....+QP000124 35..10-00011000 36..10-00004000  
11....+QP000124 35..10-00004000 36..10+00000100  
11....+QP000124 35..10+00004000 36..10-00000100  
11....+QP000124 35..10+00011000 36..10-00005000  
11....+QP000124 35..10+00012000 36..10-00002500  
11....+QP000125 35..10-00012000 36..10-00002000  
11....+QP000125 35..10-00011000 36..10-00002500  
11....+QP000125 35..10-00004000 36..10-00000070  
11....+QP000125 35..10+00004000 36..10-00000070  
11....+QP000125 35..10+00011000 36..10-00002500  
11....+QP000125 35..10+00012000 36..10-00002000  
11....+TEMPLATE 35..41-00002000 36..11+00000000  
71....+0000FILL 72....+00002000  
11....+TEMPLATE 35..41-00000500 36..11+00000000  
71....+0000FILL 72....+00000000  
11....+TEMPLATE 35..41+00000000 36..11+00000000  
71....+0000FILL 72....+00000000  
11....+TEMPLATE 35..41+00001000 36..11+00000000  
71....+0000FILL 72....+00000000  
11....+TEMPLATE 35..41+00002000 36..11+00000000  
71....+0000FILL 72....+00002000  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Elements supported.  
Cross Section  
Assignments  
Element  
Definition  
Cross Section  
number  
The number or identifier of the  
cross section  
Chainage  
The chainage from which the  
cross section is applied  
Header of the Cross Section Assignment file:  
410001+000asker 42..10+ASSIGNMT 43....+CRSASKER  
WI41 Job identification. Max. 8 ASCII characters,  
user definable.  
WI42 Cross section assignment file identification.  
May not be changed by user.  
WI43 Name of the corresponding cross section file  
A data block for a cross section assignment is  
structured as follows:  
110002+0000NORM 71....+00382000  
WI 11 The cross section number.  
WI 71 Beginning chainage for that cross section  
RP  
Comments:  
• The header consists of a single block at the start of a  
data file.  
• A cross section assignment file must have a  
corresponding cross section file.  
• A cross section remains valid until a new cross  
section is assigned.  
• A given cross section may be assigned to multiple  
chainage.  
• The units for chainage are defined in WI 42 in the  
file header.  
• For a cross section assignment file there is a  
limitation of 100 data blocks.  
298  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example:  
410001+000asker 42..10+ASSIGNMT 43....+CRSASKER  
110002+0000NORM 71....+00382000  
110003+0000NORM 71....+00552000  
110004+00000568 71....+00568000  
110005+000568.1 71....+00568100  
110006+000585.1 71....+00585100  
110007+000585.2 71....+00585200  
110008+0000NORM 71....+00611000  
110009+0000NORM 71....+00775000  
110010+00000811 71....+00811000  
110011+000826.9 71....+00826900  
110012+00000827 71....+00827000  
110013+00000827 71....+00844000  
110014+000826.9 71....+00844100  
110015+00000860 71....+00860000  
RP  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Elements supported  
Element  
Station Equations  
Definition  
Station equation The number or identifier of the  
number  
station equation  
Chainage ahead  
The chainage to be applied going  
forward along the alignment  
Chainage back  
The chainage to be applied going  
backward along the alignment  
Header of the Station Equation file :  
41....+00JOB_ID 42....+0STAEQTN  
WI41 Job identification. Max. 8 ASCII characters,  
user definable.  
WI42 Station Equation file identification. May not  
be changed by user.  
A data block for a station equation is structured as  
follows:  
41....+00000001 42....+00100000 43....+00200000  
WI 41 The station equation number.  
WI 42 Chainage ahead.  
RP  
WI 43 Chainage back.  
Comments:  
• The header consists of a single block at the start of a  
data file.  
• For a station equation file there is a limitation of 100  
data blocks.  
Example:  
41....+00JOB_ID 42....+0STAEQTN  
41....+00000001 42..10+00100000 43..10+00200000  
41....+00000002 42..10+00566000 43..10+00600000  
300  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If "Log File" is set to "ON" the measurements and the  
results are stored in the ASCII-file specified within the  
"Configuration Editor". This file is created in the  
directory LOG on the memory card. Subsequently, you  
can read the memory card on your PC and obtain a hard  
copy of the Log-file.  
Log File  
Data will always be appended to the specified Log-file.  
The Log-file contains the following information:  
Header  
includes:  
- the program used,  
- information about the instrument,  
- the file to store the measurement  
data,  
- the date and the time.  
RP  
Configuration the name of the input files for:  
- the Hz-alignment,  
- the V-alignment and  
- the cross section.  
Measurement - Instrument station with coordinates  
and instrument height.  
- Stakeout point with heigth offset,  
- offset1 and height displacement2  
relative to centre line,  
- comparison values from planning,  
and associated differences.  
1
This value results from  
- the displacement of the zero point of the profile and  
- the displacement taken from the transverse profile.  
2
This value results from  
- the displacement of the zero point of the profile and  
- the displacement taken from the transverse profile  
- the height displacement in the configuration.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica VIP RoadPlus V2.11  
Instrument  
User Templ.  
Meas. File  
:
:
:
:
TCM1100, Serial 412784, (not named)  
User 1  
FILE01.GSI  
Program Start  
04/08/1995 at 10:23  
Horizontal Aln  
Vertical Aln  
Cross Sections  
:
:
:
ALNSPORT.GSI  
PRFSPORT.GSI  
CRSSPORT.GSI  
Station  
:
1
E= 0.000m  
N= 0.000m  
ELV= 0.000m  
hi= 0.000m  
Point No.  
Chainage  
Design  
Staked  
Deltas  
:
:
:
:
:
55  
150.000, Offset= 0.000m,  
E= -79.269m, N= 19.917m, ELV= 400.501m  
E= -1.057m, N= 2.578m, ELV= 0.107m  
Hght Offset= 0.000m  
dE= -78.211m, dN= 17.339m, dELV= 400.394m  
Point No.  
Chainage  
Design  
Staked  
Deltas  
:
:
:
:
:
5
100.000, Offset= 0.000m,  
Hght Offset= 0.000m  
E= -46.305m, N= 26.708m, ELV= 400.409m  
E= -0.000m, N= 2.774m, ELV= 0.051m  
dE= -46.305m, dN= 23.934m, dELV= 400.358m  
Point No.  
Chainage  
Design  
Staked  
Deltas  
:
:
:
:
:
5
100.785, Offset= 0.000m,  
E= -46.688m, N= 27.392m, ELV= 400.365m  
E= -0.000m, N= 2.774m, ELV= 0.051m  
dE= -46.688m, dN= 24.619m, dELV= 400.314m  
Hght Offset= 0.000m  
RP  
Example of a log file for the program "ROAD PLUS"  
302  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File Editor  
The manual describes the program "FILE EDITOR  
(GSI)" of the LEICA TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite  
series. This version of the file editor is only valid for a  
GSI configuration.  
This program is used to open/to view and edit existing  
project files for the program "RoadPlus" or for creation  
of new project files.  
Introduction  
In order to create new project files, the file names must  
comply with certain rules.  
1. Horizontal Alignment File  
File Name:  
ALN?????.GSI  
2. Vertical Alignment File  
File Name:  
PRF?????.GSI  
CRS?????.GSI  
3. Template File  
FE  
File Name:  
4. Station Equation File  
File Name:  
EQN?????.GSI  
5. Cross-section Assignment File  
File Name:  
STA?????.GSI  
You can insert a permitted character for a DOS file  
name in place of a ?.  
Creation of files  
The following table shows an overview of the max. file  
sizes:  
Type of file  
Limitations  
Horizontal alignment  
Vertical alignment  
Cross section  
200 data blocks  
200 data blocks  
200 data blocks  
(number of points in a cross  
section max. 48)  
Cross section assignment 100 data blocks  
Station equation 100 data blocks  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
It is possible to insert also a new data set:  
Editing files  
• With function "Coordinate", point coordinates,  
station coordinates or a code block can be inserted.  
• With function "Horizontal Alignment" a tangent, a  
circular curve, a Spiral in, a Spiral out, a Curve in or  
a Curve out can be inserted.  
For the circular curve radius the following sign rule  
applies:  
With a right-hand curve (centre of circle right of  
alignment) the sign is positive.  
With a left-hand curve (centre of circle left of  
alignment) the sign is negative.  
• With function "Vertical Alignment" a tangent, a  
circular curve or a parabola can be inserted.  
For the circular curve radius and/or the parabola  
parameter the following sign rule applies:  
If the centre of circle is above the alignment (dip) the  
sign is positive.  
If the centre of circle is below the alignment (crest)  
the sign is negative.  
• With function "Template" an offset or a height  
difference relative to axis can be inserted.  
For the offset and/or the height difference the  
following sign rule applies:  
If the point is left of alignment the offset is negative.  
If the point is right of alignment the offset is positive.  
If the point is above the alignment the height  
difference is positive.  
If the point is below the alignment the height  
difference is negative.  
FE  
• With function "Station Equation" a number for the  
station equation, a station ahead or a station back can  
be inserted.  
• With function "Cross-section Assignment" the name  
of the template and the start station for this template  
can be inserted.  
304  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Open file  
Start program "FILE EDITOR" from the "MAIN  
MENU: PROGRAMS" dialog.  
14:03  
FilEd\ OPEN FILE  
FILE EDITOR (GSI)  
File Type :  
File Name :  
Coordinate  
FILE04.GSI  
INFO CREAT  
HELP  
LIST  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
FE  
File Type  
: Select type of file:  
Coordinate, refer to chapter  
"Coordinates"  
Horiz. Align, refer to chapter "Hori-  
zontal Alignment"  
Vert. Align, refer to chapter "Vertical  
Alignment"  
Template, refer to chapter "Template"  
Sta. Eqn., refer to chapter "Station  
Equation"  
CRS Assignmnt, refer to chapter  
"Cross-section Assignment"  
File Name  
: Select file name.  
Displays date and version of the running application.  
Create new file "Coordinate", see dialog page 306.  
View and edit existing file.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Coordinates  
Press within dialog page 305 in order to create a new  
file Coordinates (see dialog below).  
Press within dialog page 305 in order to view and edit  
the selected file (see dialog page 307 - 309).  
14:03  
Coordinate  
FilEd\ CREATE FILE  
File Type :  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
FILE06.GSI  
3
LIST  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Select file name. Only files, which are  
not created yet, can be selected.  
No.Decimals : Select number of decimals.  
Insert a new data set.  
14:03  
INSERT RECORD  
1 Insert Point Coordinates  
2 Insert Station Coordinates  
3 Insert Code Block  
FE  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Insert point coordinates, see page 307.  
Insert station coordinates, see dialog page 308.  
Insert code block, see dialog page 309.  
306  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call function "Insert Point Coordinates" in menu  
"INSERT RECORD" (page 306).  
14:03  
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
Point no. :  
2/  
3
9
Easting  
:
:
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
Northing  
Elevation :  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT IMPOR αNUM  
HELP |<-- -->|  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
FE  
Point no.  
Easting  
: Input of point number.  
: Input of easting.  
Northing  
Elevation  
: Input of northing.  
: Input of elevation.  
Display of previous point.  
Display of following point.  
Save file.  
Insert new data set, see dialog page 306, bottom.  
Import of coordinates by reading in the active  
coordinate file. This function is described in chapter  
"Select user template ..." of the "SYSTEM" Users  
Manual.  
Goto start of file.  
Goto end of file.  
Point search, see dialog page 310.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call function "Insert Station Coordinates" in menu  
"INSERT RECORD" (page 306).  
14:03  
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
3
9
Point no. :  
Stn.Eastng :  
Stn.Northg :  
Stn.Elev. :  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->|  
αNUM  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Point no.  
: Input of point number.  
Stn. Eastng : Input of station easting.  
Stn. Northg : Input of station northing.  
Stn. Elev.  
: Input of station elevation.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
307.  
FE  
308  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call function "Insert Code Block" in menu "INSERT  
RECORD" (page 306).  
14:03  
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
3
Code  
:
:
:
:
:
1
Info 1  
Info 2  
Info 3  
Info 4  
+00000000  
+00000000  
+00000000  
+00000000  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT  
αNUM  
Info 5  
Info 6  
Info 7  
:
:
:
+00000000  
+00000000  
+00000000  
HELP |<-- -->|  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
FE  
measurements, graphically.  
Code  
: Input of code number.  
Info 1-7  
: Input of information 1 to 7.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
307.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in dialogs "VIEW / EDIT  
FILE" (pages 307 - 309).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Point/Code :  
Forward  
-----  
SEARC αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
: Forward: Searching for point or  
code numbers in direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for point or  
code numbers in direction start of file.  
Point/Code : Input of point or code number.  
Point search.  
or  
FE  
310  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Horizontal Alignment  
Create new file "Horiz. Align" in dialog page 305, see  
dialog bottom.  
View and edit selected file in dialog page 305, see  
dialog page 312/314.  
14:03  
Horiz. Align  
FILED\ CREATE FILE  
File Type :  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
-----  
3
αNUM  
HELP  
FE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Input of file name (max. 5 char.), see  
chapter "Introduction".  
No.Decimals : Selection of number of decimals.  
Insert new Header, see dialog page 312.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
311  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
1
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
1/  
Job Id  
:
:
JOB_ID  
HZALIGNM  
STACOORD  
File Id  
File Type :  
SAVE INSRT  
αNUM  
HELP |<-- -->|  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1/ 1  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Job Id  
File Id  
: Input of job identification.  
: Display of horizontal alignment file.  
: Display for the main point method.  
File Type  
Save file.  
Insert new data set.  
Goto start of file.  
Goto end of file.  
Point search.  
FE  
312  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
INSERT RECORD  
1 Insert Tangent  
2 Insert Circular Curve  
3 Insert Spiral In  
4 Insert Spiral Out  
5 Insert Curve In  
6 Insert Curve Out  
7 Insert End Of Positioning  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Insert Tangent.  
Insert Circular Curve.  
Insert Spiral In.  
FE  
Insert Spiral Out.  
Insert Curve In, see dialog page 314.  
Insert Curve Out.  
Insert End Of Positioning.  
The function "Insert Curve In" is used as an example.  
For the other functions refer to dialog page 314.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call function "Insert Curve In" in menu "INSERT  
RECORD" (page 313).  
14:03  
3
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
Station  
:
:
:
:
:
0.000 m  
Ele Type  
Radius 1  
Template  
Radius 2  
Curve In  
0.000 m  
TEMPLATE  
0.000 m  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT IMPOR EDIT  
Easting  
Northing  
:
:
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
HELP |<-- -->| DEL SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Station  
: Input of station (chainage).  
: Display of geometric element.  
: Input of circular curve radius 1.  
Ele Type  
Radius 1  
Template  
: Input of name/number of cross  
section.  
FE  
Radius 2  
Easting  
: Input of circular curve radius 2.  
: Input of easting.  
Northing  
: Input of northing.  
314  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display of previous point.  
Display of following point.  
Save file.  
Insert new data set.  
Import of coordinates either by manual input or by  
reading in the active coordinate file. This function is  
described in chapter "Select user template ..." of the  
"SYSTEM" Users Manual.  
Goto start of file.  
Goto end of file.  
Delete a data block.  
Point search.  
FE  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
315  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in the dialogs "View / Edit  
File" (pages 312, 314).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Station  
Forward  
:
----- m  
SEARC EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
Station  
: Forward: Searching for station in  
direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for station in  
direction start of file.  
: Input of station (chainage).  
Search for station.  
or  
FE  
316  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vertical Alignment  
Create new file "Vert. Align" in dialog page 305, see  
dialog bottom.  
View and edit selected file in dialog page 305, see  
dialog page 318 , 319.  
14:03  
Vert. Align  
FilEd\ CREATE FILE  
File Type :  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
-----  
3
αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
FE  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Input of file name (max. 5 char.), see  
chapter "Introduction".  
No.Decimals : Selection of number of decimals.  
Insert new Header.  
14:03  
1
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
1/  
Job Id  
:
:
JOB_ID  
0VALIGNM  
STACOORD  
File Id  
File Type :  
SAVE INSRT  
αNUM  
HELP |<-- -->|  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
317  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1/ 1  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Job Id  
: Input of job identification.  
File Id  
: Display for the vertical alignment file.  
: Display for the main point method.  
File Type  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
312.  
14:03  
INSERT RECORD  
1 Insert Tangent  
2 Insert Circular Curve  
3 Insert Parabola  
4 Insert End Of Positioning  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Insert Tangent.  
FE  
Insert Circular Curve.  
Insert Parabola, see dialog page 319.  
Insert End Of Positioning.  
The function "Insert parabola" is used as an example.  
For the other functions refer to dialog page 319.  
318  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call function "Insert Parabola" in menu "INSERT  
RECORD" (page 318).  
14:03  
3
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
Station  
:
:
0.000 m  
Ele Type  
Parabola  
Parameter :  
Elevation :  
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT IMPOR EDIT  
HELP |<-- -->| DEL SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
FE  
measurements, graphically.  
Station  
: Input of station (chainage).  
: Display of geometric element.  
: Input of parabola parameter.  
: Input of elevation.  
Ele Type  
Parameter  
Elevation  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
314.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in the dialogs "View / Edit  
File" (pages 317, 319).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Station  
Forward  
:
----- m  
SEARC EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
Station  
: Forward: Searching for station in  
direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for station in  
direction start of file.  
: Input of station (chainage).  
Search for station.  
or  
FE  
320  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Template  
Create new file "Template" in dialog page 305, see  
dialog bottom.  
View and editselected file in dialog page 305, see  
dialoges page 322/323.  
14:03  
FilEd\ CREATE FILE  
File Type :  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
Template  
-----  
3
αNUM  
HELP  
FE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Input of file name (max. 5 char.), see  
chapter "Introduction".  
No.Decimals : Selection of number of decimals.  
Insert new Header, see dialog page 322.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
1
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
1/  
Job Id  
:
:
JOB_ID  
File Id  
TEMPLATE  
SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->|  
αNUM  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1/ 1  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Job Id  
File Id  
: Input of job identification.  
: Display of cross section file.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
312.  
FE  
322  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
3
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
Template  
:
TEMPLATE  
Hz-Dist. :  
0.000 m  
SO Ht diff :  
Cut/Fill  
0.000 m  
FILL  
:
Slope ratio:  
0.000  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT  
EDIT  
HELP |<-- -->| DEL SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Template  
Hz-Dist.  
SO Ht diff  
Cut/Fill  
: Input of name/number of cross section  
point.  
FE  
: Input of horiz. distance of cross  
section point.  
: Input of nom. height difference of  
cross section point to axis.  
: Selection of cross section type.  
Available are:  
CUT  
FILL  
STANDARD  
Slope ratio  
: Input of slope ratio.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
314.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
323  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in the dialogs "View / Edit  
File" (pages 322, 323).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Template  
Forward  
:
-----  
SEARC αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
Template  
: Forward: Searching for templates  
in direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for templates  
in direction start of file.  
: Input of template name.  
or  
Search for templates.  
FE  
324  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Station Equation  
Create new file "Sta. Eqn." in dialog page 305, see  
dialog bottom.  
View and edit selected file in dialog page 305, see  
dialogs page 326/327.  
14:03  
FilEd\ CREATE FILE  
File Type :  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
Sta. Eqn.  
-----  
3
αNUM  
HELP  
FE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Input of file name (max. 5 char.), see  
chapter "Introduction".  
No.Decimals : Selection of number of decimals.  
Insert new Header, see dialog page 326.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
325  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
1
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
1/  
Job Id  
:
:
JOB_ID  
File Id  
0STAEQTN  
SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->|  
αNUM  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1/ 1  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Job Id  
File Id  
: Input of job identificaton.  
: Display for the station equation file.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
312.  
FE  
326  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
Sta. Eqn. :  
2/  
3
0
Ahead  
Back  
:
:
0.000 m  
0.000 m  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->| DEL SEARC  
αNUM  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Sta. Eqn.  
Ahead  
Back  
: Input of number of station equation.  
: Input of station ahead.  
FE  
: Input of station back.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
314.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in dialogs "View / Edit File"  
(pages 326, 327).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Sta. Eqn. :  
Forward  
-----  
SEARC αNUM  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
: Forward: Searching for station  
equations in direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for station  
equations in direction start of file.  
Sta. Eqn.  
: Input of number of station equation.  
or  
Search for station equations.  
FE  
328  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cross-section Assignment  
Create new file "CRS Assignmnt" in dialog page 305,  
see dialog bottom.  
View and edit selected file in dialog pagee 305, see  
dialogs page 330/331.  
14:03  
FilEd\ CREATE FILE  
File Type : CRS Assignmnt  
File Name :  
No.Decimals:  
-----  
3
αNUM  
HELP  
FE  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
File Type  
File Name  
: Display of type of file.  
: Input of file name (max. 5 char.), see  
chapter "Introduction".  
No.Decimals : Selection of number of decimals.  
Insert new Header, see dialog page 330.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
329  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
1
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
1/  
Job Id  
:
:
:
JOB_ID  
ASSIGNMT  
File Id  
CRS File  
CRSCCCCC.GSI  
SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->|  
αNUM  
SEARC  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
1/ 1  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Job Id  
File Id  
: Input of job identification.  
: Display of section assignment file.  
: Selection of relevant cross section file.  
CRS File  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
312.  
FE  
330  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14:03  
3
FilEd\ VIEW / EDIT FILE  
2/  
Template  
Station  
:
:
TEMPLATE  
0.000 m  
<-- --> SAVE INSRT  
HELP |<-- -->| DEL SEARC  
LIST  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
2/ 3  
: Sequence number of current point and  
total number of points in the  
measurement set. The scroll bar shows  
the sequential position of the  
measurements, graphically.  
Template  
Station  
: Selection of template.  
FE  
: Input of start station for this template.  
Meaning of the function keys is similar to dialog page  
314.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
331  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Start dialog "SEARCH" in dialogs "View / Edit File"  
(pages 330, 331).  
14:03  
FilEd\  
SEARCH  
Direction :  
Station  
Forward  
:
----- m  
SEARC EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Direction  
Station  
: Forward: Searching for templates  
in direction end of file.  
Backward: Searching for templates  
in direction start of file.  
: Input of station (chainage).  
Search for station.  
or  
FE  
332  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Monitoring  
The manual describes the "Monitoring" program of the  
Leica TPS SYSTEM 1000 theodolite series.  
The program allows for automatic measurement  
repetition.  
MO  
Max. 50 measuring points and as many measurement  
repetitions as desired, at any time intervals.  
Introduction  
The instrument must be firmly mounted on a tripod or  
pillar.  
Requirements to run this program:  
• the licence number  
• a PCMCIA card which is inserted into the instrument  
By means of a timer function, the program can trigger  
the automatic measurement, at predetermined intervals,  
of points which have already been measured once and  
learned by the instrument and which are stored on the  
PCMCIA card.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The measurements can be:  
• repeated as often as is necessary,  
• at any time  
• performed in both faces.  
The point number, the horizontal and vertical angles  
and the slope distance for the individual measurements  
are stored on the memory card.  
The points to be measured must be permanently  
equipped with Leica prisms.  
The measurements are limited only by the storage  
capacity of the PCMCIA memory card.  
MO  
334  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Main menu  
14:03  
MONIT\ MONITORING MENU  
1 Point Selection  
2 Timer Selection  
3 Point Measurement  
4 End Monitoring  
INFO  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
Selection of points to be measured, see page 336.  
Set timer requirements, see page 339.  
Start point measurement, see page 340.  
Exit the "Monitoring" program.  
MO  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
335  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting points  
The points to be measured are selected from this menu:  
• by storing the appropriate measurement file, points  
already measured at the same station  
• by entering the LEARNED file, points yet to be  
determined.  
14:03  
LEARNED  
24  
MONIT\ POINT SELECTION  
Control  
:
:
:
:
Total Pts.  
Select Pts.  
Two Faces  
24  
YES  
MEAS  
SELCT LIST  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
To learn points, the "LEARNED" file must be used as a  
control file.  
To use points from another file, use  
(LIST) to  
switch to the file selection und wählen die gewünschte  
Datei.  
The point file must:  
• be in the GSI directory on the PCMCIA card,  
• include the point numbers and the angle  
measurements.  
The instrument itself must have been positioned.  
MO  
With the "Two Faces" option you can alternate between  
one-face and two-face measurement.  
If you choose the two-face option, every single  
measurement is stored on the PCMCIA card.  
Calls the measurement menu, for first-time point  
measurement.  
Calls the point selection.  
Selects from the list of GSI files.  
336  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measurement menu  
14:03  
2
MONIT\ LEARN POINT  
Point no.  
Remark 1  
Refl.Height  
Hz  
:
:
:
-----  
0.0000 m  
: 281°47'05"  
: 92°15'36"  
V
Horiz.Dist.  
:
145.4821 m  
ñ
ALL DIST REC TARGT DONE αNUM  
HELP  
I<>II  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
If the measurement file already includes points with the  
same point number, then when this function is called  
you will be asked whether the points are to be written  
over.  
For the instrument to learn a point, the prism must be  
targeted manually  
MO  
Triggering the distance measurement then initiates a  
distance measurement and a precise determination of  
the angle.  
Measure the distance.  
Store the measurement into the selected file.  
Quit the function after all points have been measured;  
return to the "POINT SELECTION" menu.  
(ALL) does not have any functions, for  
measuring and recording it is imperative to use  
and  
.
The points will be saved in the set measurement file  
(refer to chapter "Select user template and  
measurement file" of "System" - user manual).  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the points to  
be measured  
Start selection of the points to be measured in the dialog  
"POINT SELECTION" (page 336).  
14:03  
MONIT\ POINT SELECTION  
Point no.  
:
:
1
Selected  
IN  
Hz  
V
: 126°13'42"  
: 89°44'11"  
Slope Dist. :  
29.7961 m  
ñ
--> DONE OUT  
HELP NONE ALL POSIT  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
In this menu, you can select the points which you  
require for the automatic measurement.  
A selected point can be either activated or deactivated.  
Several points with the same point number can be  
present.  
When you have selected all the points you require, press  
(DONE) to quit the menu.  
Display the next point in the file.  
MO  
Quit the menu and goes to the main menu for the point  
selection (page 336).  
Alternates between switching a point "IN" and "OUT".  
No point from the current file is to be selected.  
All points from the current file are to be selected.  
Position the instrument for the point selected.  
338  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Timer selection  
14:03  
MONIT\ TIMER SELECTION  
Beg Date  
Beg Time  
End Date  
End Time  
Delay  
:
:
:
:
:
:
18/07/97  
16:00:00  
30/08/97  
00:00:00  
0h  
1m  
2
Repetitions  
EDIT  
HELP  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F1  
F2  
F3  
This menu decides when the measurement will be taken.  
Enter the date and time for the beginning and end of the  
measurement.  
An interval of at least one minute between  
measurements must be defined.  
The number of repeats can be defined in the field  
"Repetitions".  
MO  
Edit the preset values.  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
339  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Point measurement  
Choosing this option starts the measurement.  
If a point cannot be measured, the TCA starts its internal  
search routine and, if unsuccessful, goes on to the next  
point to be measured.  
Abort the automatic measurement.  
This option terminates the "Monitoring" program.  
End monitoring  
MO  
340  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Abort  
Abscissa  
Additional applications  
Alignment  
Angular correction  
Arcs  
340  
238, 241  
16  
A
175  
168  
120  
117  
Area  
Azimuth and distance  
64  
Backsight azimuth  
Base point  
Baseline points  
152  
106, 238 
B
C
95  
Calling up the program  
Calls ON-LINE help  
Calls up code input  
CAUTION  
Centre-line offset  
Chainage  
25  
26  
26  
4
171  
171  
26  
Closes application  
Coarse positioning  
60
COGO  
205  
117  
306  
329  
311  
325  
321  
Computation of area  
Create coordinate file  
Create cross-section assignment file  
Create horizontal alignment file  
Create station equation file  
Create template file  
Create vertical alignment file  
Cross section assignment  
Cross section interpolation  
Cross sections  
317  
259, 298  
260  
180, 201, 296  
IX  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DANGER  
Data exchange  
Designation of keys  
Determination of the station elevation  
Direction measurements  
4
24  
26  
27  
129  
D
F
File editor  
Free station  
303  
79  
General notes  
23  
G
H
Hidden point  
Hz-alignment  
111  
192, 291  
Important paragraphs  
Installation in the PC  
Instrument field setup  
Intersections  
Introduction  
Inverse  
4
12  
24  
221  
11  
209  
I
Licence code  
Line offset  
Loading application programs  
Loading system texts  
Local coordinates  
Local resection  
11, 21  
60  
L
20  
19  
165  
165  
165  
Local station elevation  
IX  
342  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Measurement file  
Measurement menu  
Measurement repetition  
Monitoring  
336, 337  
337  
M
333  
333  
Naming files  
15  
N
O
Offsets  
Ordinate  
Orientation  
Orientation and height transfer  
Orientation correction  
27, 32, 38, 44, 47, 84, 90, 168  
Oriented direction  
Orthogonal  
237  
238, 241  
79, 83, 168  
27  
31, 43, 83  
62  
68  
Orthogonal stakeout  
PCMCIA memory card  
Perimeter  
Point measurement  
Polar calculation  
Polar stakeout  
Pole  
Polygon mode  
Polygonal mode  
Product identification  
Project files  
334  
123, 124  
340  
P
209  
66  
111  
53, 54  
49, 58  
3
303  
Radial methods  
Radial mode  
Reference line  
Reference point  
Remote height  
Remote point  
Resection  
49  
50, 53, 54  
93, 98  
289  
R
105  
108  
39  
Road line  
Road plus  
171  
249  
IX  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
343  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scale factor  
84  
74  
336  
S
Select stakeout method  
Selecting points  
Sets of angles  
129  
Sideshot  
Sideshot point  
Sideshots  
Slope staking  
Software upload  
Stakeout  
Stakeout from coordinate differences  
Stakeout with auxiliary points  
Standard applications  
Station equations  
Superelevation  
153  
154, 155  
147  
285  
17  
59, 66, 183  
72  
70  
11, 16  
262, 300  
261  
Three point arc  
Tie distance  
Timer selection  
TRANSFER  
Traverse  
246  
49  
339  
T
19, 20  
147, 212  
153, 154, 155  
336  
Traverse point  
Two faces  
Units in this manual  
Using the program  
23  
24  
U
V-alignment  
197, 294  
V
WARNING  
WORKBENCH  
4
W
13, 14  
X-section Check  
184  
X
IX  
344  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
© Leica  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica Geosystems AG,  
Heerbrugg, Switzerland  
has been certified as being  
equipped with a quality  
system which meets the  
International Standard of  
Quality Management and  
Quality Systems  
(ISO standard 9001)  
Total Quality Management-  
Our commitment to total  
customer satisfaction  
Ask your local Leica agent for  
more information about our  
TQM program  
IX  
© Leica  
TPS-System 1000 Programs-2.3.1en  
345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leica Geosystems AG  
Geodesy  
CH-9435 Heerbrugg  
(Switzerland)  
Phone +41 71 727 31 31  
Fax +41 71 727 46 73  
www.leica.com  
664901-2.3.1en  
Printed in switzerland - Copyright Leica Geosystems AG, Heerbrugg,  
Switzerland 1998  
Translation of original text (664901-2.3.1de)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Land Pride Lawn Mower AFM4522 User Manual
Lantronix Server 900 653 R User Manual
Lenmar Enterprises Camcorder TXB46 User Manual
Lexmark Range C760 User Manual
LG Electronics Indoor Fireplace MP03 VDLPM User Manual
Magnasonic MP3 Docking Station MiDK101 User Manual
Marantz Stereo Receiver SR4500 User Manual
Maytag Cooktop MEC4436AAW User Manual
Mazda Automobile 2006 5 User Manual
Memorex Karaoke Machine MKS SS1 User Manual